annotate man/custom.texi @ 62508:39dc00cd1f8a

(copyright-fix-years): Make sure all years are fixed. Don't insert a space after a dash.
author Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
date Thu, 19 May 2005 08:13:31 +0000
parents 463dbe69de36
children c8d5956c919b f042e7c0fe20
Ignore whitespace changes - Everywhere: Within whitespace: At end of lines:
rev   line source
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1 @c This is part of the Emacs manual.
61606
e348d86e70f8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 61051
diff changeset
2 @c Copyright (C) 1985,86,87,93,94,95,97,2000,2001,2002,2004,2005
28126
e7cf77f27506 Fix copyright line.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 27218
diff changeset
3 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4 @c See file emacs.texi for copying conditions.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5 @node Customization, Quitting, Amusements, Top
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6 @chapter Customization
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7 @cindex customization
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
8
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
9 This chapter talks about various topics relevant to adapting the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
10 behavior of Emacs in minor ways. See @cite{The Emacs Lisp Reference
40519
9b9cd5d7c886 Add xref to X Resources.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 39544
diff changeset
11 Manual} for how to make more far-reaching changes. @xref{X Resources},
9b9cd5d7c886 Add xref to X Resources.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 39544
diff changeset
12 for information on using X resources to customize Emacs.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
13
38322
245114062ee0 Explain more clearly what it takes to make a customization permanent.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38114
diff changeset
14 Customization that you do within Emacs normally affects only the
56165
920d5b4fe0a2 * msdog.texi (Text and Binary, MS-DOS Printing): Use m-dash.
Jesper Harder <harder@ifa.au.dk>
parents: 56085
diff changeset
15 particular Emacs session that you do it in---it does not persist
38322
245114062ee0 Explain more clearly what it takes to make a customization permanent.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38114
diff changeset
16 between sessions unless you save the customization in a file such as
38744
d7121931b3ba Show example of specifying C-M-= in Lisp.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38605
diff changeset
17 @file{.emacs} or @file{.Xdefaults} that will affect future sessions.
d7121931b3ba Show example of specifying C-M-= in Lisp.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38605
diff changeset
18 @xref{Init File}. In the customization buffer, when you save
d7121931b3ba Show example of specifying C-M-= in Lisp.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38605
diff changeset
19 customizations for future sessions, this actually works by editing
d7121931b3ba Show example of specifying C-M-= in Lisp.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38605
diff changeset
20 @file{.emacs} for you.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
21
52227
fd6d7ba60ecf (Customization): Add xref to Keyboard Macros chapter.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51448
diff changeset
22 Another means of customization is the keyboard macro, which is a
fd6d7ba60ecf (Customization): Add xref to Keyboard Macros chapter.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51448
diff changeset
23 sequence of keystrokes to be replayed with a single command.
fd6d7ba60ecf (Customization): Add xref to Keyboard Macros chapter.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51448
diff changeset
24 @xref{Keyboard Macros}, for full instruction how to record, manage, and
fd6d7ba60ecf (Customization): Add xref to Keyboard Macros chapter.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51448
diff changeset
25 replay sequences of keys.
fd6d7ba60ecf (Customization): Add xref to Keyboard Macros chapter.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 51448
diff changeset
26
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
27 @menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
28 * Minor Modes:: Each minor mode is one feature you can turn on
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
29 independently of any others.
62475
463dbe69de36 (Customization): Fix menu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents: 61606
diff changeset
30 * Easy Customization:: Convenient way to browse and change user options.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
31 * Variables:: Many Emacs commands examine Emacs variables
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
32 to decide what to do; by setting variables,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
33 you can control their functioning.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
34 * Key Bindings:: The keymaps say what command each key runs.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
35 By changing them, you can "redefine keys".
62475
463dbe69de36 (Customization): Fix menu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents: 61606
diff changeset
36 * Keyboard Translations:: If your keyboard passes an undesired code
463dbe69de36 (Customization): Fix menu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents: 61606
diff changeset
37 for a key, you can tell Emacs to
463dbe69de36 (Customization): Fix menu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents: 61606
diff changeset
38 substitute another code.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
39 * Syntax:: The syntax table controls how words and
62475
463dbe69de36 (Customization): Fix menu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents: 61606
diff changeset
40 expressions are parsed.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
41 * Init File:: How to write common customizations in the
49600
23a1cea22d13 Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 47535
diff changeset
42 @file{.emacs} file.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
43 @end menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
44
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
45 @node Minor Modes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
46 @section Minor Modes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
47 @cindex minor modes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
48 @cindex mode, minor
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
49
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
50 Minor modes are optional features which you can turn on or off. For
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
51 example, Auto Fill mode is a minor mode in which @key{SPC} breaks lines
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
52 between words as you type. All the minor modes are independent of each
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
53 other and of the selected major mode. Most minor modes say in the mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
54 line when they are on; for example, @samp{Fill} in the mode line means
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
55 that Auto Fill mode is on.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
56
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
57 Append @code{-mode} to the name of a minor mode to get the name of a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
58 command function that turns the mode on or off. Thus, the command to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
59 enable or disable Auto Fill mode is called @kbd{M-x auto-fill-mode}. These
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
60 commands are usually invoked with @kbd{M-x}, but you can bind keys to them
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
61 if you wish. With no argument, the function turns the mode on if it was
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
62 off and off if it was on. This is known as @dfn{toggling}. A positive
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
63 argument always turns the mode on, and an explicit zero argument or a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
64 negative argument always turns it off.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
65
38322
245114062ee0 Explain more clearly what it takes to make a customization permanent.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38114
diff changeset
66 Some minor modes are global: while enabled, they affect everything
245114062ee0 Explain more clearly what it takes to make a customization permanent.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38114
diff changeset
67 you do in the Emacs session, in all buffers. Other minor modes are
245114062ee0 Explain more clearly what it takes to make a customization permanent.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38114
diff changeset
68 buffer-local; they apply only to the current buffer, so you can enable
245114062ee0 Explain more clearly what it takes to make a customization permanent.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38114
diff changeset
69 the mode in certain buffers and not others.
245114062ee0 Explain more clearly what it takes to make a customization permanent.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38114
diff changeset
70
245114062ee0 Explain more clearly what it takes to make a customization permanent.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38114
diff changeset
71 For most minor modes, the command name is also the name of a
245114062ee0 Explain more clearly what it takes to make a customization permanent.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38114
diff changeset
72 variable which directly controls the mode. The mode is enabled
245114062ee0 Explain more clearly what it takes to make a customization permanent.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38114
diff changeset
73 whenever this variable's value is non-@code{nil}, and the minor-mode
245114062ee0 Explain more clearly what it takes to make a customization permanent.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38114
diff changeset
74 command works by setting the variable. For example, the command
245114062ee0 Explain more clearly what it takes to make a customization permanent.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38114
diff changeset
75 @code{outline-minor-mode} works by setting the value of
245114062ee0 Explain more clearly what it takes to make a customization permanent.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38114
diff changeset
76 @code{outline-minor-mode} as a variable; it is this variable that
245114062ee0 Explain more clearly what it takes to make a customization permanent.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38114
diff changeset
77 directly turns Outline minor mode on and off. To check whether a
245114062ee0 Explain more clearly what it takes to make a customization permanent.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38114
diff changeset
78 given minor mode works this way, use @kbd{C-h v} to ask for
245114062ee0 Explain more clearly what it takes to make a customization permanent.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38114
diff changeset
79 documentation on the variable name.
245114062ee0 Explain more clearly what it takes to make a customization permanent.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38114
diff changeset
80
245114062ee0 Explain more clearly what it takes to make a customization permanent.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38114
diff changeset
81 These minor-mode variables provide a good way for Lisp programs to turn
245114062ee0 Explain more clearly what it takes to make a customization permanent.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38114
diff changeset
82 minor modes on and off; they are also useful in a file's local variables
245114062ee0 Explain more clearly what it takes to make a customization permanent.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38114
diff changeset
83 list. But please think twice before setting minor modes with a local
59949
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
84 variables list, because most minor modes are a matter of user
38322
245114062ee0 Explain more clearly what it takes to make a customization permanent.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38114
diff changeset
85 preference---other users editing the same file might not want the same
245114062ee0 Explain more clearly what it takes to make a customization permanent.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38114
diff changeset
86 minor modes you prefer.
245114062ee0 Explain more clearly what it takes to make a customization permanent.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38114
diff changeset
87
245114062ee0 Explain more clearly what it takes to make a customization permanent.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38114
diff changeset
88 The buffer-local minor modes include Abbrev mode, Auto Fill mode,
38870
d44abb4e68b2 Don't use "print" for displaying a message.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38791
diff changeset
89 Auto Save mode, Font-Lock mode, Glasses mode, ISO Accents mode,
d44abb4e68b2 Don't use "print" for displaying a message.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38791
diff changeset
90 Outline minor mode, Overwrite mode, and Binary Overwrite mode.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
91
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
92 Abbrev mode allows you to define abbreviations that automatically expand
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
93 as you type them. For example, @samp{amd} might expand to @samp{abbrev
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
94 mode}. @xref{Abbrevs}, for full information.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
95
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
96 Auto Fill mode allows you to enter filled text without breaking lines
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
97 explicitly. Emacs inserts newlines as necessary to prevent lines from
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
98 becoming too long. @xref{Filling}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
99
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
100 Auto Save mode causes the contents of a buffer to be saved
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
101 periodically to reduce the amount of work you can lose in case of a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
102 system crash. @xref{Auto Save}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
103
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
104 Enriched mode enables editing and saving of formatted text.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
105 @xref{Formatted Text}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
106
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
107 Flyspell mode automatically highlights misspelled words.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
108 @xref{Spelling}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
109
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
110 Font-Lock mode automatically highlights certain textual units found in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
111 programs, such as comments, strings, and function names being defined.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
112 This requires a window system that can display multiple fonts.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
113 @xref{Faces}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
114
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
115 ISO Accents mode makes the characters @samp{`}, @samp{'}, @samp{"},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
116 @samp{^}, @samp{/} and @samp{~} combine with the following letter, to
38744
d7121931b3ba Show example of specifying C-M-= in Lisp.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38605
diff changeset
117 produce an accented letter in the ISO Latin-1 character set. The
d7121931b3ba Show example of specifying C-M-= in Lisp.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38605
diff changeset
118 newer and more general feature of input methods more or less
d7121931b3ba Show example of specifying C-M-= in Lisp.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38605
diff changeset
119 supersedes ISO Accents mode. @xref{Single-Byte Character Support}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
120
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
121 Outline minor mode provides the same facilities as the major mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
122 called Outline mode; but since it is a minor mode instead, you can
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
123 combine it with any major mode. @xref{Outline Mode}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
124
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
125 @cindex Overwrite mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
126 @cindex mode, Overwrite
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
127 Overwrite mode causes ordinary printing characters to replace existing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
128 text instead of shoving it to the right. For example, if point is in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
129 front of the @samp{B} in @samp{FOOBAR}, then in Overwrite mode typing a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
130 @kbd{G} changes it to @samp{FOOGAR}, instead of producing @samp{FOOGBAR}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
131 as usual. In Overwrite mode, the command @kbd{C-q} inserts the next
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
132 character whatever it may be, even if it is a digit---this gives you a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
133 way to insert a character instead of replacing an existing character.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
134
37571
9628e53b601d Document that overwrite-mode is bound to INSERT and add @kindex for INSERT.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37419
diff changeset
135 @findex overwrite-mode
9628e53b601d Document that overwrite-mode is bound to INSERT and add @kindex for INSERT.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37419
diff changeset
136 @kindex INSERT
9628e53b601d Document that overwrite-mode is bound to INSERT and add @kindex for INSERT.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37419
diff changeset
137 The command @code{overwrite-mode} is an exception to the rule that
9628e53b601d Document that overwrite-mode is bound to INSERT and add @kindex for INSERT.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37419
diff changeset
138 commands which toggle minor modes are normally not bound to keys: it is
9628e53b601d Document that overwrite-mode is bound to INSERT and add @kindex for INSERT.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37419
diff changeset
139 bound to the @key{INSERT} function key. This is because many other
9628e53b601d Document that overwrite-mode is bound to INSERT and add @kindex for INSERT.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37419
diff changeset
140 programs bind @key{INSERT} to similar functions.
9628e53b601d Document that overwrite-mode is bound to INSERT and add @kindex for INSERT.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37419
diff changeset
141
9628e53b601d Document that overwrite-mode is bound to INSERT and add @kindex for INSERT.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37419
diff changeset
142 @findex binary-overwrite-mode
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
143 Binary Overwrite mode is a variant of Overwrite mode for editing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
144 binary files; it treats newlines and tabs like other characters, so that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
145 they overwrite other characters and can be overwritten by them.
37843
e8365cfcb741 Explain how Binary Overwrite mode affects C-q.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37618
diff changeset
146 In Binary Overwrite mode, digits after @kbd{C-q} specify an
e8365cfcb741 Explain how Binary Overwrite mode affects C-q.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37618
diff changeset
147 octal character code, as usual.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
148
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
149 The following minor modes normally apply to all buffers at once.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
150 Since each is enabled or disabled by the value of a variable, you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
151 @emph{can} set them differently for particular buffers, by explicitly
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
152 making the corresponding variables local in those buffers.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
153 @xref{Locals}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
154
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
155 Icomplete mode displays an indication of available completions when
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
156 you are in the minibuffer and completion is active. @xref{Completion
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
157 Options}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
158
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
159 Line Number mode enables continuous display in the mode line of the
36148
a2719b6e7a2f Don't use naked lambdas in examples. Fix bad @xref usage.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35188
diff changeset
160 line number of point, and Column Number mode enables display of the
28126
e7cf77f27506 Fix copyright line.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 27218
diff changeset
161 column number. @xref{Mode Line}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
162
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
163 Scroll Bar mode gives each window a scroll bar (@pxref{Scroll Bars}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
164 Menu Bar mode gives each frame a menu bar (@pxref{Menu Bars}). Both of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
165 these modes are enabled by default when you use the X Window System.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
166
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
167 In Transient Mark mode, every change in the buffer contents
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
168 ``deactivates'' the mark, so that commands that operate on the region
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
169 will get an error. This means you must either set the mark, or
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
170 explicitly ``reactivate'' it, before each command that uses the region.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
171 The advantage of Transient Mark mode is that Emacs can display the
28126
e7cf77f27506 Fix copyright line.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 27218
diff changeset
172 region highlighted (currently only when using X). @xref{Mark}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
173
58763
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
174 @node Easy Customization
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
175 @section Easy Customization Interface
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
176
58763
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
177 @cindex user option
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
178 Emacs has many @dfn{user options} which have values that you can set
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
179 in order to customize various commands. Many user options are
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
180 documented in this manual. Most user options are actually Lisp
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
181 variables (@pxref{Variables}), so their names appear in the Variable
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
182 Index (@pxref{Variable Index}). The rest are faces and their
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
183 attributes (@pxref{Faces}).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
184
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
185 @findex customize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
186 @cindex customization buffer
58763
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
187 You can browse interactively through the the user options and change
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
188 some of them using @kbd{M-x customize}. This command creates a
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
189 @dfn{customization buffer}, which offers commands to navigate through
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
190 a logically organized structure of the Emacs user options; you can
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
191 also use it to edit and set their values, and to save settings
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
192 permanently in your @file{~/.emacs} file (@pxref{Init File}).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
193
58763
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
194 The appearance of the example buffers in this section is typically
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
195 different under a window system, since faces are then used to indicate
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
196 the active fields and other features.
31075
9c560a17ef4a (Changing an Option): Change load-path example.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
197
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
198 @menu
59949
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
199 * Groups: Customization Groups. How options are classified in a structure.
59802
67941974673e (Easy Customization): Adapt menu to node name change.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 59800
diff changeset
200 * Changing a Variable:: How to edit a value and set an option.
47535
761358848235 (Saving Customizations): New node has the info on custom-file.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46890
diff changeset
201 * Saving Customizations:: Details of saving customizations.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
202 * Face Customization:: How to edit the attributes of a face.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
203 * Specific Customization:: Making a customization buffer for specific
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
204 variables, faces, or groups.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
205 @end menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
206
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
207 @node Customization Groups
58763
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
208 @subsection Customization Groups
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
209 @cindex customization groups
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
210
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
211 For customization purposes, user options are organized into
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
212 @dfn{groups} to help you find them. Groups are collected into bigger
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
213 groups, all the way up to a master group called @code{Emacs}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
214
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
215 @kbd{M-x customize} creates a customization buffer that shows the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
216 top-level @code{Emacs} group and the second-level groups immediately
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
217 under it. It looks like this, in part:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
218
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
219 @smallexample
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
220 /- Emacs group: ---------------------------------------------------\
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
221 [State]: visible group members are all at standard settings.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
222 Customization of the One True Editor.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
223 See also [Manual].
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
224
37977
5ff6cac52888 Update Customization buffer examples
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37976
diff changeset
225 Confirm Kill Emacs: [Hide] [Value Menu] Don't confirm
5ff6cac52888 Update Customization buffer examples
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37976
diff changeset
226 [State]: this option is unchanged from its standard setting.
5ff6cac52888 Update Customization buffer examples
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37976
diff changeset
227 How to ask for confirmation when leaving Emacs. [More]
5ff6cac52888 Update Customization buffer examples
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37976
diff changeset
228
49600
23a1cea22d13 Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 47535
diff changeset
229 Editing group: [Go to Group]
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
230 Basic text editing facilities.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
231
49600
23a1cea22d13 Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 47535
diff changeset
232 External group: [Go to Group]
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
233 Interfacing to external utilities.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
234
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
235 @var{more second-level groups}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
236
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
237 \- Emacs group end ------------------------------------------------/
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
238
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
239 @end smallexample
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
240
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
241 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
242 This says that the buffer displays the contents of the @code{Emacs}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
243 group. The other groups are listed because they are its contents. But
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
244 they are listed differently, without indentation and dashes, because
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
245 @emph{their} contents are not included. Each group has a single-line
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
246 documentation string; the @code{Emacs} group also has a @samp{[State]}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
247 line.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
248
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
249 @cindex editable fields (customization buffer)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
250 @cindex active fields (customization buffer)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
251 Most of the text in the customization buffer is read-only, but it
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
252 typically includes some @dfn{editable fields} that you can edit. There
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
253 are also @dfn{active fields}; this means a field that does something
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
254 when you @dfn{invoke} it. To invoke an active field, either click on it
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
255 with @kbd{Mouse-1}, or move point to it and type @key{RET}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
256
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
257 For example, the phrase @samp{[Go to Group]} that appears in a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
258 second-level group is an active field. Invoking the @samp{[Go to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
259 Group]} field for a group creates a new customization buffer, which
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
260 shows that group and its contents. This field is a kind of hypertext
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
261 link to another group.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
262
38744
d7121931b3ba Show example of specifying C-M-= in Lisp.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38605
diff changeset
263 The @code{Emacs} group includes a few user options itself, but
d7121931b3ba Show example of specifying C-M-= in Lisp.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38605
diff changeset
264 mainly it contains other groups, which contain more groups, which
d7121931b3ba Show example of specifying C-M-= in Lisp.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38605
diff changeset
265 contain the user options. By browsing the hierarchy of groups, you
d7121931b3ba Show example of specifying C-M-= in Lisp.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38605
diff changeset
266 will eventually find the feature you are interested in customizing.
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
267 Then you can use the customization buffer to set the options
38744
d7121931b3ba Show example of specifying C-M-= in Lisp.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38605
diff changeset
268 pertaining to that feature. You can also go straight to a particular
d7121931b3ba Show example of specifying C-M-= in Lisp.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38605
diff changeset
269 group by name, using the command @kbd{M-x customize-group}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
270
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
271 @findex customize-browse
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
272 You can view the structure of customization groups on a larger scale
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
273 with @kbd{M-x customize-browse}. This command creates a special kind of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
274 customization buffer which shows only the names of the groups (and
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
275 variables and faces), and their structure.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
276
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
277 In this buffer, you can show the contents of a group by invoking
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
278 @samp{[+]}. When the group contents are visible, this button changes to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
279 @samp{[-]}; invoking that hides the group contents.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
280
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
281 Each group, variable, or face name in this buffer has an active field
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
282 which says @samp{[Group]}, @samp{[Variable]} or @samp{[Face]}. Invoking
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
283 that active field creates an ordinary customization buffer showing just
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
284 that group and its contents, just that variable, or just that face.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
285 This is the way to set values in it.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
286
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
287 @node Changing a Variable
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
288 @subsection Changing a Variable
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
289
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
290 Here is an example of what a variable looks like in the
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
291 customization buffer:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
292
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
293 @smallexample
37977
5ff6cac52888 Update Customization buffer examples
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37976
diff changeset
294 Kill Ring Max: [Hide] 60
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
295 [State]: this variable is unchanged from its standard setting.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
296 Maximum length of kill ring before oldest elements are thrown away.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
297 @end smallexample
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
298
37977
5ff6cac52888 Update Customization buffer examples
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37976
diff changeset
299 The text following @samp{[Hide]}, @samp{60} in this case, indicates
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
300 the current value of the variable. If you see @samp{[Show]} instead of
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
301 @samp{[Hide]}, it means that the value is hidden; the customization
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
302 buffer initially hides values that take up several lines. Invoke
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
303 @samp{[Show]} to show the value.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
304
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
305 The line after the option name indicates the @dfn{customization state}
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
306 of the variable: in the example above, it says you have not changed the
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
307 option yet. The word @samp{[State]} at the beginning of this line is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
308 active; you can get a menu of various operations by invoking it with
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
309 @kbd{Mouse-1} or @key{RET}. These operations are essential for
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
310 customizing the variable.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
311
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
312 The line after the @samp{[State]} line displays the beginning of the
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
313 variable's documentation string. If there are more lines of
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
314 documentation, this line ends with @samp{[More]}; invoke this to show
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
315 the full documentation string.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
316
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
317 To enter a new value for @samp{Kill Ring Max}, move point to the value
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
318 and edit it textually. For example, you can type @kbd{M-d}, then insert
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
319 another number.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
320
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
321 When you begin to alter the text, you will see the @samp{[State]} line
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
322 change to say that you have edited the value:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
323
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
324 @smallexample
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
325 [State]: you have edited the value as text, but not set the variable.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
326 @end smallexample
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
327
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
328 @cindex setting option value
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
329 Editing the value does not actually set the variable. To do
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
330 that, you must @dfn{set} it. To do this, invoke the word
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
331 @samp{[State]} and choose @samp{Set for Current Session}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
332
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
333 The state of the variable changes visibly when you set it:
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
334
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
335 @smallexample
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
336 [State]: you have set this variable, but not saved it for future sessions.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
337 @end smallexample
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
338
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
339 You don't have to worry about specifying a value that is not valid;
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
340 setting the variable checks for validity and will not really install an
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
341 unacceptable value.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
342
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
343 @kindex M-TAB @r{(customization buffer)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
344 @findex widget-complete
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
345 While editing a value or field that is a file name, directory name,
60423
ad01c2a006c4 (Changing a Variable): C-M-i like M-TAB.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59996
diff changeset
346 command name, or anything else for which completion is defined, you
ad01c2a006c4 (Changing a Variable): C-M-i like M-TAB.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59996
diff changeset
347 can type @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} (@code{widget-complete}) to do completion.
ad01c2a006c4 (Changing a Variable): C-M-i like M-TAB.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59996
diff changeset
348 (@kbd{@key{ESC} @key{TAB}} and @kbd{C-M-i} do the same thing.)
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
349
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
350 Some variables have a small fixed set of possible legitimate values.
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
351 These variables don't let you edit the value textually. Instead, an
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
352 active field @samp{[Value Menu]} appears before the value; invoke this
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
353 field to edit the value. For a boolean ``on or off'' value, the active
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
354 field says @samp{[Toggle]}, and it changes to the other value.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
355 @samp{[Value Menu]} and @samp{[Toggle]} edit the buffer; the changes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
356 take effect when you use the @samp{Set for Current Session} operation.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
357
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
358 Some variables have values with complex structure. For example, the
31075
9c560a17ef4a (Changing an Option): Change load-path example.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
359 value of @code{file-coding-system-alist} is an association list. Here
9c560a17ef4a (Changing an Option): Change load-path example.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
360 is how it appears in the customization buffer:
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
361
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
362 @smallexample
31075
9c560a17ef4a (Changing an Option): Change load-path example.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
363 File Coding System Alist: [Hide]
9c560a17ef4a (Changing an Option): Change load-path example.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
364 [INS] [DEL] File regexp: \.elc\'
9c560a17ef4a (Changing an Option): Change load-path example.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
365 Choice: [Value Menu] Encoding/decoding pair:
9c560a17ef4a (Changing an Option): Change load-path example.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
366 Decoding: emacs-mule
9c560a17ef4a (Changing an Option): Change load-path example.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
367 Encoding: emacs-mule
9c560a17ef4a (Changing an Option): Change load-path example.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
368 [INS] [DEL] File regexp: \(\`\|/\)loaddefs.el\'
9c560a17ef4a (Changing an Option): Change load-path example.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
369 Choice: [Value Menu] Encoding/decoding pair:
37977
5ff6cac52888 Update Customization buffer examples
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37976
diff changeset
370 Decoding: raw-text
5ff6cac52888 Update Customization buffer examples
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37976
diff changeset
371 Encoding: raw-text-unix
31075
9c560a17ef4a (Changing an Option): Change load-path example.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
372 [INS] [DEL] File regexp: \.tar\'
9c560a17ef4a (Changing an Option): Change load-path example.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
373 Choice: [Value Menu] Encoding/decoding pair:
9c560a17ef4a (Changing an Option): Change load-path example.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
374 Decoding: no-conversion
9c560a17ef4a (Changing an Option): Change load-path example.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
375 Encoding: no-conversion
9c560a17ef4a (Changing an Option): Change load-path example.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
376 [INS] [DEL] File regexp:
9c560a17ef4a (Changing an Option): Change load-path example.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
377 Choice: [Value Menu] Encoding/decoding pair:
9c560a17ef4a (Changing an Option): Change load-path example.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
378 Decoding: undecided
9c560a17ef4a (Changing an Option): Change load-path example.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
379 Encoding: nil
36148
a2719b6e7a2f Don't use naked lambdas in examples. Fix bad @xref usage.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35188
diff changeset
380 [INS]
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
381 [State]: this variable is unchanged from its standard setting.
31075
9c560a17ef4a (Changing an Option): Change load-path example.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
382 Alist to decide a coding system to use for a file I/O operation. [Hide]
36148
a2719b6e7a2f Don't use naked lambdas in examples. Fix bad @xref usage.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35188
diff changeset
383 The format is ((PATTERN . VAL) ...),
a2719b6e7a2f Don't use naked lambdas in examples. Fix bad @xref usage.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35188
diff changeset
384 where PATTERN is a regular expression matching a file name,
a2719b6e7a2f Don't use naked lambdas in examples. Fix bad @xref usage.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35188
diff changeset
385 @r{[@dots{}more lines of documentation@dots{}]}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
386 @end smallexample
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
387
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
388 @noindent
36148
a2719b6e7a2f Don't use naked lambdas in examples. Fix bad @xref usage.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35188
diff changeset
389 Each association in the list appears on four lines, with several
a2719b6e7a2f Don't use naked lambdas in examples. Fix bad @xref usage.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35188
diff changeset
390 editable or ``active'' fields. You can edit the regexps and coding
a2719b6e7a2f Don't use naked lambdas in examples. Fix bad @xref usage.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35188
diff changeset
391 systems using ordinary editing commands. You can also invoke
a2719b6e7a2f Don't use naked lambdas in examples. Fix bad @xref usage.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35188
diff changeset
392 @samp{[Value Menu]} to switch to a kind of value---for instance, to
a2719b6e7a2f Don't use naked lambdas in examples. Fix bad @xref usage.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35188
diff changeset
393 specify a function instead of a pair of coding systems.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
394
36148
a2719b6e7a2f Don't use naked lambdas in examples. Fix bad @xref usage.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35188
diff changeset
395 To delete an association from the list, invoke the @samp{[DEL]} button
a2719b6e7a2f Don't use naked lambdas in examples. Fix bad @xref usage.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35188
diff changeset
396 for that item. To add an association, invoke @samp{[INS]} at the
a2719b6e7a2f Don't use naked lambdas in examples. Fix bad @xref usage.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35188
diff changeset
397 position where you want to add it. There is an @samp{[INS]} button
a2719b6e7a2f Don't use naked lambdas in examples. Fix bad @xref usage.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35188
diff changeset
398 between each pair of association, another at the beginning and another
a2719b6e7a2f Don't use naked lambdas in examples. Fix bad @xref usage.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35188
diff changeset
399 at the end, so you can add the new association at any position in the
a2719b6e7a2f Don't use naked lambdas in examples. Fix bad @xref usage.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35188
diff changeset
400 list.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
401
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
402 @kindex TAB @r{(customization buffer)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
403 @kindex S-TAB @r{(customization buffer)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
404 @findex widget-forward
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
405 @findex widget-backward
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
406 Two special commands, @key{TAB} and @kbd{S-@key{TAB}}, are useful for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
407 moving through the customization buffer. @key{TAB}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
408 (@code{widget-forward}) moves forward to the next active or editable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
409 field; @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} (@code{widget-backward}) moves backward to the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
410 previous active or editable field.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
411
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
412 Typing @key{RET} on an editable field also moves forward, just like
36148
a2719b6e7a2f Don't use naked lambdas in examples. Fix bad @xref usage.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35188
diff changeset
413 @key{TAB}. We set it up this way because people often type @key{RET}
a2719b6e7a2f Don't use naked lambdas in examples. Fix bad @xref usage.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35188
diff changeset
414 when they are finished editing a field. To insert a newline within an
a2719b6e7a2f Don't use naked lambdas in examples. Fix bad @xref usage.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35188
diff changeset
415 editable field, use @kbd{C-o} or @kbd{C-q C-j}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
416
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
417 @cindex saving variable value
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
418 @cindex customized variables, saving
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
419 Setting the variable changes its value in the current Emacs session;
47535
761358848235 (Saving Customizations): New node has the info on custom-file.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46890
diff changeset
420 @dfn{saving} the value changes it for future sessions as well. To
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
421 save the variable, invoke @samp{[State]} and select the @samp{Save for
47535
761358848235 (Saving Customizations): New node has the info on custom-file.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46890
diff changeset
422 Future Sessions} operation. This works by writing code so as to set
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
423 the variable again, each time you start Emacs (@pxref{Saving
47535
761358848235 (Saving Customizations): New node has the info on custom-file.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46890
diff changeset
424 Customizations}).
37618
764853859fbc (Changing an Option): Document that "emacs -q" cannot save customizations.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37596
diff changeset
425
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
426 You can also restore the variable to its standard value by invoking
47535
761358848235 (Saving Customizations): New node has the info on custom-file.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46890
diff changeset
427 @samp{[State]} and selecting the @samp{Erase Customization} operation.
761358848235 (Saving Customizations): New node has the info on custom-file.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46890
diff changeset
428 There are actually three reset operations:
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
429
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
430 @table @samp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
431 @item Reset
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
432 If you have made some modifications and not yet set the variable,
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
433 this restores the text in the customization buffer to match
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
434 the actual value.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
435
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
436 @item Reset to Saved
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
437 This restores the value of the variable to the last saved value,
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
438 and updates the text accordingly.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
439
27218
ff77115434db Doc recent changes in Custom.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26392
diff changeset
440 @item Erase Customization
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
441 This sets the variable to its standard value, and updates the text
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
442 accordingly. This also eliminates any saved value for the option,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
443 so that you will get the standard value in future Emacs sessions.
47535
761358848235 (Saving Customizations): New node has the info on custom-file.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46890
diff changeset
444
761358848235 (Saving Customizations): New node has the info on custom-file.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46890
diff changeset
445 @item Use Backup Value
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
446 This sets the variable to a previous value that was set in the
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
447 customization buffer in this session. If you customize a variable
58763
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
448 and then reset it, which discards the customized value,
47535
761358848235 (Saving Customizations): New node has the info on custom-file.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46890
diff changeset
449 you can get the customized value back again with this operation.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
450 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
451
27218
ff77115434db Doc recent changes in Custom.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26392
diff changeset
452 @cindex comments on customized options
36148
a2719b6e7a2f Don't use naked lambdas in examples. Fix bad @xref usage.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35188
diff changeset
453 Sometimes it is useful to record a comment about a specific
a2719b6e7a2f Don't use naked lambdas in examples. Fix bad @xref usage.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35188
diff changeset
454 customization. Use the @samp{Add Comment} item from the
a2719b6e7a2f Don't use naked lambdas in examples. Fix bad @xref usage.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35188
diff changeset
455 @samp{[State]} menu to create a field for entering the comment. The
a2719b6e7a2f Don't use naked lambdas in examples. Fix bad @xref usage.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35188
diff changeset
456 comment you enter will be saved, and displayed again if you again view
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
457 the same variable in a customization buffer, even in another session.
27218
ff77115434db Doc recent changes in Custom.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26392
diff changeset
458
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
459 The state of a group indicates whether anything in that group has been
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
460 edited, set or saved. You can select @samp{Set for Current Session},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
461 @samp{Save for Future Sessions} and the various kinds of @samp{Reset}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
462 operation for the group; these operations on the group apply to all
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
463 options in the group and its subgroups.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
464
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
465 Near the top of the customization buffer there are two lines
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
466 containing several active fields:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
467
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
468 @smallexample
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
469 [Set for Current Session] [Save for Future Sessions]
27218
ff77115434db Doc recent changes in Custom.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26392
diff changeset
470 [Reset] [Reset to Saved] [Erase Customization] [Finish]
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
471 @end smallexample
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
472
36593
4567e1729217 custom-buffer-done-function <- Custom-buffer-done
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36292
diff changeset
473 @vindex custom-buffer-done-function
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
474 @noindent
27218
ff77115434db Doc recent changes in Custom.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26392
diff changeset
475 Invoking @samp{[Finish]} either buries or kills this customization
36593
4567e1729217 custom-buffer-done-function <- Custom-buffer-done
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36292
diff changeset
476 buffer according to the setting of the option
4567e1729217 custom-buffer-done-function <- Custom-buffer-done
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36292
diff changeset
477 @code{custom-buffer-done-function}; the default is to bury the buffer.
4567e1729217 custom-buffer-done-function <- Custom-buffer-done
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36292
diff changeset
478 Each of the other fields performs an operation---set, save or
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
479 reset---on each of the options in the buffer that could meaningfully
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
480 be set, saved or reset. They do not operate on options whose values
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
481 are hidden.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
482
47535
761358848235 (Saving Customizations): New node has the info on custom-file.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46890
diff changeset
483 @node Saving Customizations
58763
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
484 @subsection Saving Customizations
47535
761358848235 (Saving Customizations): New node has the info on custom-file.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46890
diff changeset
485
761358848235 (Saving Customizations): New node has the info on custom-file.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46890
diff changeset
486 @vindex custom-file
761358848235 (Saving Customizations): New node has the info on custom-file.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46890
diff changeset
487 The customization buffer normally saves customizations in
761358848235 (Saving Customizations): New node has the info on custom-file.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46890
diff changeset
488 @file{~/.emacs}. If you wish, you can save customizations in another
761358848235 (Saving Customizations): New node has the info on custom-file.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46890
diff changeset
489 file instead. To make this work, your @file{~/.emacs} should set
59353
c13a0c603028 (Saving Customizations): Minor improvement.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59336
diff changeset
490 @code{custom-file} to the name of that file. Then you should load the
c13a0c603028 (Saving Customizations): Minor improvement.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59336
diff changeset
491 file by calling @code{load}. For example:
47535
761358848235 (Saving Customizations): New node has the info on custom-file.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46890
diff changeset
492
761358848235 (Saving Customizations): New node has the info on custom-file.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46890
diff changeset
493 @example
59336
b442f3501e4e (Saving Customizations): Emacs no longer loads `custom-file' after
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 59282
diff changeset
494 (setq custom-file "~/.emacs-custom.el")
b442f3501e4e (Saving Customizations): Emacs no longer loads `custom-file' after
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 59282
diff changeset
495 (load custom-file)
47535
761358848235 (Saving Customizations): New node has the info on custom-file.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46890
diff changeset
496 @end example
761358848235 (Saving Customizations): New node has the info on custom-file.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46890
diff changeset
497
58861
2e075e3c65a4 (Saving Customizations): Emacs only loads the custom file
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 58764
diff changeset
498 You can also use @code{custom-file} to specify different
2e075e3c65a4 (Saving Customizations): Emacs only loads the custom file
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 58764
diff changeset
499 customization files for different Emacs versions, like this:
47535
761358848235 (Saving Customizations): New node has the info on custom-file.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46890
diff changeset
500
761358848235 (Saving Customizations): New node has the info on custom-file.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46890
diff changeset
501 @example
58861
2e075e3c65a4 (Saving Customizations): Emacs only loads the custom file
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 58764
diff changeset
502 (cond ((< emacs-major-version 21)
2e075e3c65a4 (Saving Customizations): Emacs only loads the custom file
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 58764
diff changeset
503 ;; @r{Emacs 20 customization.}
2e075e3c65a4 (Saving Customizations): Emacs only loads the custom file
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 58764
diff changeset
504 (setq custom-file "~/.custom-20.el"))
2e075e3c65a4 (Saving Customizations): Emacs only loads the custom file
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 58764
diff changeset
505 ((and (= emacs-major-version 21) (< emacs-minor-version 4))
2e075e3c65a4 (Saving Customizations): Emacs only loads the custom file
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 58764
diff changeset
506 ;; @r{Emacs 21 customization, before version 21.4.}
2e075e3c65a4 (Saving Customizations): Emacs only loads the custom file
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 58764
diff changeset
507 (setq custom-file "~/.custom-21.el"))
59996
aac0a33f5772 Change release version from 21.4 to 22.1 throughout.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 59961
diff changeset
508 ((< emacs-major-version 22)
58861
2e075e3c65a4 (Saving Customizations): Emacs only loads the custom file
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 58764
diff changeset
509 ;; @r{Emacs version 21.4 or later.}
59996
aac0a33f5772 Change release version from 21.4 to 22.1 throughout.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 59961
diff changeset
510 (setq custom-file "~/.custom-21.4.el"))
aac0a33f5772 Change release version from 21.4 to 22.1 throughout.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 59961
diff changeset
511 (t
aac0a33f5772 Change release version from 21.4 to 22.1 throughout.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 59961
diff changeset
512 ;; @r{Emacs version 22.1 or later.}
aac0a33f5772 Change release version from 21.4 to 22.1 throughout.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 59961
diff changeset
513 (setq custom-file "~/.custom-22.el")))
58861
2e075e3c65a4 (Saving Customizations): Emacs only loads the custom file
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 58764
diff changeset
514
2e075e3c65a4 (Saving Customizations): Emacs only loads the custom file
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 58764
diff changeset
515 (load custom-file)
47535
761358848235 (Saving Customizations): New node has the info on custom-file.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46890
diff changeset
516 @end example
761358848235 (Saving Customizations): New node has the info on custom-file.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46890
diff changeset
517
761358848235 (Saving Customizations): New node has the info on custom-file.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46890
diff changeset
518 If Emacs was invoked with the @option{-q} or @option{--no-init-file}
761358848235 (Saving Customizations): New node has the info on custom-file.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46890
diff changeset
519 options (@pxref{Initial Options}), it will not let you save your
761358848235 (Saving Customizations): New node has the info on custom-file.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46890
diff changeset
520 customizations in your @file{~/.emacs} init file. This is because
761358848235 (Saving Customizations): New node has the info on custom-file.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46890
diff changeset
521 saving customizations from such a session would wipe out all the other
761358848235 (Saving Customizations): New node has the info on custom-file.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46890
diff changeset
522 customizations you might have on your init file.
761358848235 (Saving Customizations): New node has the info on custom-file.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 46890
diff changeset
523
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
524 @node Face Customization
58763
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
525 @subsection Customizing Faces
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
526 @cindex customizing faces
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
527 @cindex bold font
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
528 @cindex italic font
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
529 @cindex fonts and faces
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
530
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
531 In addition to variables, some customization groups also include
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
532 faces. When you show the contents of a group, both the variables and
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
533 the faces in the group appear in the customization buffer. Here is an
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
534 example of how a face looks:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
535
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
536 @smallexample
44278
2f0122b0b947 Update the `customize-face' example to reflect current reality.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 43062
diff changeset
537 Custom Changed Face:(sample) [Hide]
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
538 [State]: this face is unchanged from its standard setting.
44278
2f0122b0b947 Update the `customize-face' example to reflect current reality.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 43062
diff changeset
539 Face used when the customize item has been changed.
2f0122b0b947 Update the `customize-face' example to reflect current reality.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 43062
diff changeset
540 Parent groups: => Custom Magic Faces
2f0122b0b947 Update the `customize-face' example to reflect current reality.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 43062
diff changeset
541 Attributes: [ ] Font Family: *
2f0122b0b947 Update the `customize-face' example to reflect current reality.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 43062
diff changeset
542 [ ] Width: *
2f0122b0b947 Update the `customize-face' example to reflect current reality.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 43062
diff changeset
543 [ ] Height: *
2f0122b0b947 Update the `customize-face' example to reflect current reality.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 43062
diff changeset
544 [ ] Weight: *
2f0122b0b947 Update the `customize-face' example to reflect current reality.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 43062
diff changeset
545 [ ] Slant: *
2f0122b0b947 Update the `customize-face' example to reflect current reality.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 43062
diff changeset
546 [ ] Underline: *
2f0122b0b947 Update the `customize-face' example to reflect current reality.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 43062
diff changeset
547 [ ] Overline: *
2f0122b0b947 Update the `customize-face' example to reflect current reality.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 43062
diff changeset
548 [ ] Strike-through: *
2f0122b0b947 Update the `customize-face' example to reflect current reality.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 43062
diff changeset
549 [ ] Box around text: *
2f0122b0b947 Update the `customize-face' example to reflect current reality.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 43062
diff changeset
550 [ ] Inverse-video: *
2f0122b0b947 Update the `customize-face' example to reflect current reality.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 43062
diff changeset
551 [X] Foreground: white (sample)
2f0122b0b947 Update the `customize-face' example to reflect current reality.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 43062
diff changeset
552 [X] Background: blue (sample)
2f0122b0b947 Update the `customize-face' example to reflect current reality.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 43062
diff changeset
553 [ ] Stipple: *
2f0122b0b947 Update the `customize-face' example to reflect current reality.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 43062
diff changeset
554 [ ] Inherit: *
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
555 @end smallexample
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
556
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
557 Each face attribute has its own line. The @samp{[@var{x}]} field
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
558 before the attribute name indicates whether the attribute is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
559 @dfn{enabled}; @samp{X} means that it is. You can enable or disable the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
560 attribute by invoking that field. When the attribute is enabled, you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
561 can change the attribute value in the usual ways.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
562
59282
b7abe21b4ff3 (Face Customization): Mention hex color specs.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59192
diff changeset
563 For the colors, you can specify a color name (use @kbd{M-x
b7abe21b4ff3 (Face Customization): Mention hex color specs.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59192
diff changeset
564 list-colors-display}) for a list of them) or a hexadecimal color
b7abe21b4ff3 (Face Customization): Mention hex color specs.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59192
diff changeset
565 specification of the form @samp{#@var{rr}@var{gg}@var{bb}}.
b7abe21b4ff3 (Face Customization): Mention hex color specs.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59192
diff changeset
566 (@samp{#000000} is black, @samp{#ff0000} is red, @samp{#00ff00} is
b7abe21b4ff3 (Face Customization): Mention hex color specs.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59192
diff changeset
567 green, @samp{#0000ff} is blue, and @samp{#ffffff} is white.) On a
b7abe21b4ff3 (Face Customization): Mention hex color specs.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59192
diff changeset
568 black-and-white display, the colors you can use for the background are
b7abe21b4ff3 (Face Customization): Mention hex color specs.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59192
diff changeset
569 @samp{black}, @samp{white}, @samp{gray}, @samp{gray1}, and
b7abe21b4ff3 (Face Customization): Mention hex color specs.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59192
diff changeset
570 @samp{gray3}. Emacs supports these shades of gray by using background
b7abe21b4ff3 (Face Customization): Mention hex color specs.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59192
diff changeset
571 stipple patterns instead of a color.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
572
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
573 Setting, saving and resetting a face work like the same operations for
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
574 variables (@pxref{Changing a Variable}).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
575
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
576 A face can specify different appearances for different types of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
577 display. For example, a face can make text red on a color display, but
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
578 use a bold font on a monochrome display. To specify multiple
37977
5ff6cac52888 Update Customization buffer examples
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37976
diff changeset
579 appearances for a face, select @samp{Show all display specs} in the menu you
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
580 get from invoking @samp{[State]}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
581
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
582 @findex modify-face
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
583 Another more basic way to set the attributes of a specific face is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
584 with @kbd{M-x modify-face}. This command reads the name of a face, then
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
585 reads the attributes one by one. For the color and stipple attributes,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
586 the attribute's current value is the default---type just @key{RET} if
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
587 you don't want to change that attribute. Type @samp{none} if you want
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
588 to clear out the attribute.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
589
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
590 @node Specific Customization
58763
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
591 @subsection Customizing Specific Items
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
592
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
593 Instead of finding the options you want to change by moving down
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
594 through the structure of groups, you can specify the particular variable,
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
595 face, or group that you want to customize.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
596
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
597 @table @kbd
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
598 @item M-x customize-variable @key{RET} @var{variable} @key{RET}
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
599 Set up a customization buffer with just one variable, @var{variable}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
600 @item M-x customize-face @key{RET} @var{face} @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
601 Set up a customization buffer with just one face, @var{face}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
602 @item M-x customize-group @key{RET} @var{group} @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
603 Set up a customization buffer with just one group, @var{group}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
604 @item M-x customize-apropos @key{RET} @var{regexp} @key{RET}
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
605 Set up a customization buffer with all the variables, faces and groups
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
606 that match @var{regexp}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
607 @item M-x customize-changed-options @key{RET} @var{version} @key{RET}
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
608 Set up a customization buffer with all the variables, faces and groups
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
609 whose meaning has changed since Emacs version @var{version}.
49600
23a1cea22d13 Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 47535
diff changeset
610 @item M-x customize-saved
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
611 Set up a customization buffer containing all variables and faces that you
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
612 have saved with customization buffers.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
613 @item M-x customize-customized
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
614 Set up a customization buffer containing all variables and faces that you
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
615 have customized but not saved.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
616 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
617
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
618 @findex customize-variable
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
619 If you want to alter a particular variable with the customization
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
620 buffer, and you know its name, you can use the command @kbd{M-x
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
621 customize-variable} and specify the variable name. This sets up the
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
622 customization buffer with just one variable---the one that you asked
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
623 for. Editing, setting and saving the value work as described above,
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
624 but only for the specified variable.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
625
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
626 @findex customize-face
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
627 Likewise, you can modify a specific face, chosen by name, using
46039
3c5d96a2d05f Doc default arg for customize-face.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
628 @kbd{M-x customize-face}. By default it operates on the face used
3c5d96a2d05f Doc default arg for customize-face.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 45979
diff changeset
629 on the character after point.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
630
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
631 @findex customize-group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
632 You can also set up the customization buffer with a specific group,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
633 using @kbd{M-x customize-group}. The immediate contents of the chosen
58763
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
634 group, including user options, faces, and other groups, all appear
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
635 as well. However, these subgroups' own contents start out hidden. You
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
636 can show their contents in the usual way, by invoking @samp{[Show]}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
637
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
638 @findex customize-apropos
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
639 To control more precisely what to customize, you can use @kbd{M-x
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
640 customize-apropos}. You specify a regular expression as argument; then
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
641 all options, faces and groups whose names match this regular expression
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
642 are set up in the customization buffer. If you specify an empty regular
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
643 expression, this includes @emph{all} groups, options and faces in the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
644 customization buffer (but that takes a long time).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
645
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
646 @findex customize-changed-options
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
647 When you upgrade to a new Emacs version, you might want to customize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
648 new options and options whose meanings or default values have changed.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
649 To do this, use @kbd{M-x customize-changed-options} and specify a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
650 previous Emacs version number using the minibuffer. It creates a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
651 customization buffer which shows all the options (and groups) whose
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
652 definitions have been changed since the specified version.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
653
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
654 @findex customize-saved
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
655 @findex customize-customized
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
656 If you change option values and then decide the change was a
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
657 mistake, you can use two special commands to revisit your previous
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
658 changes. Use @kbd{M-x customize-saved} to look at the options that
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
659 you have saved. Use @kbd{M-x customize-customized} to look at the
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
660 options that you have set but not saved.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
661
58763
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
662 @node Variables
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
663 @section Variables
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
664 @cindex variable
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
665 @cindex option, user
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
666 @cindex user option
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
667
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
668 A @dfn{variable} is a Lisp symbol which has a value. The symbol's
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
669 name is also called the name of the variable. A variable name can
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
670 contain any characters that can appear in a file, but conventionally
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
671 variable names consist of words separated by hyphens. A variable can
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
672 have a documentation string which describes what kind of value it should
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
673 have and how the value will be used.
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
674
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
675 Lisp allows any variable to have any kind of value, but most variables
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
676 that Emacs uses need a value of a certain type. Often the value should
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
677 always be a string, or should always be a number. Sometimes we say that a
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
678 certain feature is turned on if a variable is ``non-@code{nil},'' meaning
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
679 that if the variable's value is @code{nil}, the feature is off, but the
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
680 feature is on for @emph{any} other value. The conventional value to use to
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
681 turn on the feature---since you have to pick one particular value when you
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
682 set the variable---is @code{t}.
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
683
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
684 Emacs uses many Lisp variables for internal record keeping, but the
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
685 most interesting variables for a non-programmer user are those that
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
686 are also @dfn{user options}, the variables that are meant for users to
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
687 change. Each user option that you can set with the customization
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
688 buffer is (if it is not a face) in fact a Lisp variable. Emacs does
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
689 not (usually) change the values of these variables; instead, you set
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
690 the values, and thereby alter and control the behavior of certain
59949
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
691 Emacs commands. Use of the customization buffer is explained above
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
692 (@pxref{Easy Customization}); here we describe other aspects of Emacs
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
693 variables.
58763
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
694
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
695 @menu
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
696 * Examining:: Examining or setting one variable's value.
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
697 * Hooks:: Hook variables let you specify programs for parts
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
698 of Emacs to run on particular occasions.
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
699 * Locals:: Per-buffer values of variables.
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
700 * File Variables:: How files can specify variable values.
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
701 @end menu
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
702
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
703 @node Examining
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
704 @subsection Examining and Setting Variables
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
705 @cindex setting variables
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
706
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
707 @table @kbd
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
708 @item C-h v @var{var} @key{RET}
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
709 Display the value and documentation of variable @var{var}
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
710 (@code{describe-variable}).
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
711 @item M-x set-variable @key{RET} @var{var} @key{RET} @var{value} @key{RET}
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
712 Change the value of variable @var{var} to @var{value}.
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
713 @end table
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
714
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
715 To examine the value of a single variable, use @kbd{C-h v}
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
716 (@code{describe-variable}), which reads a variable name using the
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
717 minibuffer, with completion. It displays both the value and the
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
718 documentation of the variable. For example,
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
719
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
720 @example
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
721 C-h v fill-column @key{RET}
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
722 @end example
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
723
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
724 @noindent
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
725 displays something like this:
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
726
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
727 @smallexample
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
728 fill-column's value is 70
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
729
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
730 Documentation:
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
731 *Column beyond which automatic line-wrapping should happen.
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
732 Automatically becomes buffer-local when set in any fashion.
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
733 @end smallexample
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
734
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
735 @noindent
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
736 The star at the beginning of the documentation indicates that this
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
737 variable is a user option. @kbd{C-h v} is not restricted to user
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
738 options; it allows any variable name.
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
739
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
740 @findex set-variable
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
741 The most convenient way to set a specific user option variable is
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
742 with @kbd{M-x set-variable}. This reads the variable name with the
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
743 minibuffer (with completion), and then reads a Lisp expression for the
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
744 new value using the minibuffer a second time. For example,
58763
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
745
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
746 @example
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
747 M-x set-variable @key{RET} fill-column @key{RET} 75 @key{RET}
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
748 @end example
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
749
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
750 @noindent
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
751 sets @code{fill-column} to 75.
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
752
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
753 @kbd{M-x set-variable} is limited to user option variables, but you can
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
754 set any variable with a Lisp expression, using the function @code{setq}.
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
755 Here is a @code{setq} expression to set @code{fill-column}:
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
756
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
757 @example
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
758 (setq fill-column 75)
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
759 @end example
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
760
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
761 To execute an expression like this one, go to the @samp{*scratch*}
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
762 buffer, type in the expression, and then type @kbd{C-j}. @xref{Lisp
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
763 Interaction}.
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
764
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
765 Setting variables, like all means of customizing Emacs except where
59949
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
766 otherwise stated, affects only the current Emacs session. The only
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
767 way to alter the variable in future sessions is to put something in
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
768 the @file{~/.emacs} file to set it those sessions (@pxref{Init File}).
58763
25b217a7d2af (Easy Customization): Move up to section level,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58624
diff changeset
769
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
770 @node Hooks
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
771 @subsection Hooks
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
772 @cindex hook
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
773 @cindex running a hook
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
774
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
775 @dfn{Hooks} are an important mechanism for customization of Emacs. A
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
776 hook is a Lisp variable which holds a list of functions, to be called on
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
777 some well-defined occasion. (This is called @dfn{running the hook}.)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
778 The individual functions in the list are called the @dfn{hook functions}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
779 of the hook. With rare exceptions, hooks in Emacs are empty when Emacs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
780 starts up, so the only hook functions in any given hook are the ones you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
781 explicitly put there as customization.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
782
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
783 Most major modes run one or more @dfn{mode hooks} as the last step of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
784 initialization. This makes it easy for you to customize the behavior of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
785 the mode, by setting up a hook function to override the local variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
786 assignments already made by the mode. But hooks are also used in other
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
787 contexts. For example, the hook @code{suspend-hook} runs just before
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
788 Emacs suspends itself (@pxref{Exiting}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
789
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
790 @cindex normal hook
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
791 Most Emacs hooks are @dfn{normal hooks}. This means that running the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
792 hook operates by calling all the hook functions, unconditionally, with
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
793 no arguments. We have made an effort to keep most hooks normal so that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
794 you can use them in a uniform way. Every variable in Emacs whose name
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
795 ends in @samp{-hook} is a normal hook.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
796
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
797 @cindex abnormal hook
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
798 There are also a few @dfn{abnormal hooks}. These variables' names end
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
799 in @samp{-hooks} or @samp{-functions}, instead of @samp{-hook}. What
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
800 makes these hooks abnormal is that there is something peculiar about the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
801 way its functions are called---perhaps they are given arguments, or
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
802 perhaps the values they return are used in some way. For example,
45979
87962bf716e3 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 44783
diff changeset
803 @code{find-file-not-found-functions} (@pxref{Visiting}) is abnormal because
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
804 as soon as one hook function returns a non-@code{nil} value, the rest
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
805 are not called at all. The documentation of each abnormal hook variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
806 explains in detail what is peculiar about it.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
807
57156
a830d2693f6e (Hooks): Explain using setq to clear out a hook.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56785
diff changeset
808 You can set a hook variable with @code{setq} like any other Lisp
a830d2693f6e (Hooks): Explain using setq to clear out a hook.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56785
diff changeset
809 variable, but the recommended way to add a hook function to a hook
a830d2693f6e (Hooks): Explain using setq to clear out a hook.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56785
diff changeset
810 (either normal or abnormal) is by calling @code{add-hook}. You can
a830d2693f6e (Hooks): Explain using setq to clear out a hook.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56785
diff changeset
811 specify any valid Lisp function as the hook function, provided it can
a830d2693f6e (Hooks): Explain using setq to clear out a hook.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56785
diff changeset
812 handle the proper number of arguments (zero arguments, in the case of
a830d2693f6e (Hooks): Explain using setq to clear out a hook.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56785
diff changeset
813 a normal hook). Of course, not every Lisp function is @emph{useful}
a830d2693f6e (Hooks): Explain using setq to clear out a hook.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56785
diff changeset
814 in any particular hook.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
815
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
816 For example, here's how to set up a hook to turn on Auto Fill mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
817 when entering Text mode and other modes based on Text mode:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
818
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
819 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
820 (add-hook 'text-mode-hook 'turn-on-auto-fill)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
821 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
822
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
823 The next example shows how to use a hook to customize the indentation
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
824 of C code. (People often have strong personal preferences for one
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
825 format compared to another.) Here the hook function is an anonymous
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
826 lambda expression.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
827
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
828 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
829 @group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
830 (setq my-c-style
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
831 '((c-comment-only-line-offset . 4)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
832 @end group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
833 @group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
834 (c-cleanup-list . (scope-operator
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
835 empty-defun-braces
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
836 defun-close-semi))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
837 @end group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
838 @group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
839 (c-offsets-alist . ((arglist-close . c-lineup-arglist)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
840 (substatement-open . 0)))))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
841 @end group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
842
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
843 @group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
844 (add-hook 'c-mode-common-hook
36593
4567e1729217 custom-buffer-done-function <- Custom-buffer-done
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36292
diff changeset
845 '(lambda ()
4567e1729217 custom-buffer-done-function <- Custom-buffer-done
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 36292
diff changeset
846 (c-add-style "my-style" my-c-style t)))
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
847 @end group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
848 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
849
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
850 It is best to design your hook functions so that the order in which
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
851 they are executed does not matter. Any dependence on the order is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
852 ``asking for trouble.'' However, the order is predictable: the most
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
853 recently added hook functions are executed first.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
854
57156
a830d2693f6e (Hooks): Explain using setq to clear out a hook.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56785
diff changeset
855 If you play with adding various different versions of a hook
a830d2693f6e (Hooks): Explain using setq to clear out a hook.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56785
diff changeset
856 function by calling @code{add-hook} over and over, remember that all
a830d2693f6e (Hooks): Explain using setq to clear out a hook.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56785
diff changeset
857 the versions you added will remain in the hook variable together.
a830d2693f6e (Hooks): Explain using setq to clear out a hook.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56785
diff changeset
858 To clear them out, you can do @code{(setq @var{hook-variable} nil)}.
a830d2693f6e (Hooks): Explain using setq to clear out a hook.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56785
diff changeset
859
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
860 @node Locals
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
861 @subsection Local Variables
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
862
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
863 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
864 @item M-x make-local-variable @key{RET} @var{var} @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
865 Make variable @var{var} have a local value in the current buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
866 @item M-x kill-local-variable @key{RET} @var{var} @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
867 Make variable @var{var} use its global value in the current buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
868 @item M-x make-variable-buffer-local @key{RET} @var{var} @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
869 Mark variable @var{var} so that setting it will make it local to the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
870 buffer that is current at that time.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
871 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
872
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
873 @cindex local variables
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
874 Almost any variable can be made @dfn{local} to a specific Emacs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
875 buffer. This means that its value in that buffer is independent of its
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
876 value in other buffers. A few variables are always local in every
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
877 buffer. Every other Emacs variable has a @dfn{global} value which is in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
878 effect in all buffers that have not made the variable local.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
879
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
880 @findex make-local-variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
881 @kbd{M-x make-local-variable} reads the name of a variable and makes it
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
882 local to the current buffer. Further changes in this buffer will not
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
883 affect others, and further changes in the global value will not affect this
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
884 buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
885
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
886 @findex make-variable-buffer-local
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
887 @cindex per-buffer variables
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
888 @kbd{M-x make-variable-buffer-local} reads the name of a variable and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
889 changes the future behavior of the variable so that it will become local
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
890 automatically when it is set. More precisely, once a variable has been
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
891 marked in this way, the usual ways of setting the variable automatically
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
892 do @code{make-local-variable} first. We call such variables
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
893 @dfn{per-buffer} variables.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
894
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
895 Major modes (@pxref{Major Modes}) always make variables local to the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
896 buffer before setting the variables. This is why changing major modes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
897 in one buffer has no effect on other buffers. Minor modes also work by
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
898 setting variables---normally, each minor mode has one controlling
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
899 variable which is non-@code{nil} when the mode is enabled (@pxref{Minor
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
900 Modes}). For most minor modes, the controlling variable is per buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
901
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
902 Emacs contains a number of variables that are always per-buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
903 These include @code{abbrev-mode}, @code{auto-fill-function},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
904 @code{case-fold-search}, @code{comment-column}, @code{ctl-arrow},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
905 @code{fill-column}, @code{fill-prefix}, @code{indent-tabs-mode},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
906 @code{left-margin}, @code{mode-line-format}, @code{overwrite-mode},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
907 @code{selective-display-ellipses}, @code{selective-display},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
908 @code{tab-width}, and @code{truncate-lines}. Some other variables are
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
909 always local in every buffer, but they are used for internal
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
910 purposes.@refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
911
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
912 A few variables cannot be local to a buffer because they are always
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
913 local to each display instead (@pxref{Multiple Displays}). If you try to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
914 make one of these variables buffer-local, you'll get an error message.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
915
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
916 @findex kill-local-variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
917 @kbd{M-x kill-local-variable} reads the name of a variable and makes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
918 it cease to be local to the current buffer. The global value of the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
919 variable henceforth is in effect in this buffer. Setting the major mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
920 kills all the local variables of the buffer except for a few variables
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
921 specially marked as @dfn{permanent locals}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
922
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
923 @findex setq-default
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
924 To set the global value of a variable, regardless of whether the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
925 variable has a local value in the current buffer, you can use the Lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
926 construct @code{setq-default}. This construct is used just like
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
927 @code{setq}, but it sets variables' global values instead of their local
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
928 values (if any). When the current buffer does have a local value, the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
929 new global value may not be visible until you switch to another buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
930 Here is an example:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
931
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
932 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
933 (setq-default fill-column 75)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
934 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
935
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
936 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
937 @code{setq-default} is the only way to set the global value of a variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
938 that has been marked with @code{make-variable-buffer-local}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
939
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
940 @findex default-value
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
941 Lisp programs can use @code{default-value} to look at a variable's
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
942 default value. This function takes a symbol as argument and returns its
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
943 default value. The argument is evaluated; usually you must quote it
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
944 explicitly. For example, here's how to obtain the default value of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
945 @code{fill-column}:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
946
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
947 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
948 (default-value 'fill-column)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
949 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
950
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
951 @node File Variables
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
952 @subsection Local Variables in Files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
953 @cindex local variables in files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
954 @cindex file local variables
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
955
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
956 A file can specify local variable values for use when you edit the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
957 file with Emacs. Visiting the file checks for local variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
958 specifications; it automatically makes these variables local to the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
959 buffer, and sets them to the values specified in the file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
960
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
961 There are two ways to specify local variable values: in the first
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
962 line, or with a local variables list. Here's how to specify them in the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
963 first line:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
964
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
965 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
966 -*- mode: @var{modename}; @var{var}: @var{value}; @dots{} -*-
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
967 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
968
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
969 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
970 You can specify any number of variables/value pairs in this way, each
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
971 pair with a colon and semicolon as shown above. @code{mode:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
972 @var{modename};} specifies the major mode; this should come first in the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
973 line. The @var{value}s are not evaluated; they are used literally.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
974 Here is an example that specifies Lisp mode and sets two variables with
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
975 numeric values:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
976
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
977 @smallexample
36632
1bfc2fad762a (File Variables): Fix a typo.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36593
diff changeset
978 ;; -*- mode: Lisp; fill-column: 75; comment-column: 50; -*-
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
979 @end smallexample
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
980
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
981 You can also specify the coding system for a file in this way: just
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
982 specify a value for the ``variable'' named @code{coding}. The ``value''
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
983 must be a coding system name that Emacs recognizes. @xref{Coding
58624
a322009ca3d0 * custom.texi (File Variables): Add `unibyte' and make it more
Reiner Steib <Reiner.Steib@gmx.de>
parents: 57156
diff changeset
984 Systems}. @w{@samp{unibyte: t}} specifies unibyte loading for a
a322009ca3d0 * custom.texi (File Variables): Add `unibyte' and make it more
Reiner Steib <Reiner.Steib@gmx.de>
parents: 57156
diff changeset
985 particular Lisp file. @xref{Enabling Multibyte}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
986
34116
1c497211a58d Docment that `eval' can be used with local variables in the first
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 31075
diff changeset
987 The @code{eval} pseudo-variable, described below, can be specified in
1c497211a58d Docment that `eval' can be used with local variables in the first
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 31075
diff changeset
988 the first line as well.
1c497211a58d Docment that `eval' can be used with local variables in the first
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 31075
diff changeset
989
1c497211a58d Docment that `eval' can be used with local variables in the first
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 31075
diff changeset
990 @cindex shell scripts, and local file variables
1c497211a58d Docment that `eval' can be used with local variables in the first
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 31075
diff changeset
991 In shell scripts, the first line is used to identify the script
39263
343d48d4e64c Spelling corrections.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 39161
diff changeset
992 interpreter, so you cannot put any local variables there. To accommodate
34116
1c497211a58d Docment that `eval' can be used with local variables in the first
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 31075
diff changeset
993 for this, when Emacs visits a shell script, it looks for local variable
1c497211a58d Docment that `eval' can be used with local variables in the first
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 31075
diff changeset
994 specifications in the @emph{second} line.
1c497211a58d Docment that `eval' can be used with local variables in the first
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 31075
diff changeset
995
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
996 A @dfn{local variables list} goes near the end of the file, in the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
997 last page. (It is often best to put it on a page by itself.) The local
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
998 variables list starts with a line containing the string @samp{Local
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
999 Variables:}, and ends with a line containing the string @samp{End:}. In
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1000 between come the variable names and values, one set per line, as
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1001 @samp{@var{variable}:@: @var{value}}. The @var{value}s are not
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1002 evaluated; they are used literally. If a file has both a local
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1003 variables list and a @samp{-*-} line, Emacs processes @emph{everything}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1004 in the @samp{-*-} line first, and @emph{everything} in the local
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1005 variables list afterward.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1006
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1007 Here is an example of a local variables list:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1008
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1009 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1010 ;;; Local Variables: ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1011 ;;; mode:lisp ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1012 ;;; comment-column:0 ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1013 ;;; comment-start: ";;; " ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1014 ;;; comment-end:"***" ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1015 ;;; End: ***
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1016 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1017
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1018 As you see, each line starts with the prefix @samp{;;; } and each line
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1019 ends with the suffix @samp{ ***}. Emacs recognizes these as the prefix
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1020 and suffix based on the first line of the list, by finding them
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1021 surrounding the magic string @samp{Local Variables:}; then it
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1022 automatically discards them from the other lines of the list.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1023
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1024 The usual reason for using a prefix and/or suffix is to embed the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1025 local variables list in a comment, so it won't confuse other programs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1026 that the file is intended as input for. The example above is for a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1027 language where comment lines start with @samp{;;; } and end with
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1028 @samp{***}; the local values for @code{comment-start} and
57156
a830d2693f6e (Hooks): Explain using setq to clear out a hook.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56785
diff changeset
1029 @code{comment-end} customize the rest of Emacs for this unusual
a830d2693f6e (Hooks): Explain using setq to clear out a hook.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56785
diff changeset
1030 syntax. Don't use a prefix (or a suffix) if you don't need one.
a830d2693f6e (Hooks): Explain using setq to clear out a hook.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56785
diff changeset
1031
a830d2693f6e (Hooks): Explain using setq to clear out a hook.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56785
diff changeset
1032 If you write a multi-line string value, you should put the prefix
a830d2693f6e (Hooks): Explain using setq to clear out a hook.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56785
diff changeset
1033 and suffix on each line, even lines that start or end within the
a830d2693f6e (Hooks): Explain using setq to clear out a hook.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56785
diff changeset
1034 string. They will be stripped off for processing the list. If you
a830d2693f6e (Hooks): Explain using setq to clear out a hook.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56785
diff changeset
1035 want to split a long string across multiple lines of the file, you can
a830d2693f6e (Hooks): Explain using setq to clear out a hook.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56785
diff changeset
1036 use backslash-newline, which is ignored in Lisp string constants.
a830d2693f6e (Hooks): Explain using setq to clear out a hook.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56785
diff changeset
1037 Here's an example of doing this:
a830d2693f6e (Hooks): Explain using setq to clear out a hook.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56785
diff changeset
1038
a830d2693f6e (Hooks): Explain using setq to clear out a hook.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56785
diff changeset
1039 @example
a830d2693f6e (Hooks): Explain using setq to clear out a hook.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56785
diff changeset
1040 # Local Variables:
a830d2693f6e (Hooks): Explain using setq to clear out a hook.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56785
diff changeset
1041 # compile-command: "cc foo.c -Dfoo=bar -Dhack=whatever \
a830d2693f6e (Hooks): Explain using setq to clear out a hook.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56785
diff changeset
1042 # -Dmumble=blaah"
a830d2693f6e (Hooks): Explain using setq to clear out a hook.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56785
diff changeset
1043 # End:
a830d2693f6e (Hooks): Explain using setq to clear out a hook.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56785
diff changeset
1044 @end example
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1045
58624
a322009ca3d0 * custom.texi (File Variables): Add `unibyte' and make it more
Reiner Steib <Reiner.Steib@gmx.de>
parents: 57156
diff changeset
1046 Some ``variable names'' have special meanings in a local variables
59192
f6c4c15febd7 (File Variables): Clarify previous change.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58861
diff changeset
1047 list. Specifying the ``variable'' @code{mode} really sets the major
f6c4c15febd7 (File Variables): Clarify previous change.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58861
diff changeset
1048 mode, while any value specified for the ``variable'' @code{eval} is
f6c4c15febd7 (File Variables): Clarify previous change.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58861
diff changeset
1049 simply evaluated as an expression (its value is ignored). A value for
f6c4c15febd7 (File Variables): Clarify previous change.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58861
diff changeset
1050 @code{coding} specifies the coding system for character code
f6c4c15febd7 (File Variables): Clarify previous change.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58861
diff changeset
1051 conversion of this file, and a value of @code{t} for @code{unibyte}
f6c4c15febd7 (File Variables): Clarify previous change.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58861
diff changeset
1052 says to visit the file in a unibyte buffer. These four ``variables''
f6c4c15febd7 (File Variables): Clarify previous change.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58861
diff changeset
1053 are not really variables; setting them in any other context has no
f6c4c15febd7 (File Variables): Clarify previous change.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58861
diff changeset
1054 special meaning.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1055
59192
f6c4c15febd7 (File Variables): Clarify previous change.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58861
diff changeset
1056 @emph{If @code{mode} is used to set a major mode, it should be the
f6c4c15febd7 (File Variables): Clarify previous change.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58861
diff changeset
1057 first ``variable'' in the list.} Otherwise, the entries that precede
f6c4c15febd7 (File Variables): Clarify previous change.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58861
diff changeset
1058 it will usually be ignored, since most modes kill all local variables
f6c4c15febd7 (File Variables): Clarify previous change.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58861
diff changeset
1059 as part of their initialization.
f6c4c15febd7 (File Variables): Clarify previous change.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58861
diff changeset
1060
f6c4c15febd7 (File Variables): Clarify previous change.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58861
diff changeset
1061 You can use the @code{mode} ``variable'' to set minor modes as well
f6c4c15febd7 (File Variables): Clarify previous change.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58861
diff changeset
1062 as the major modes; in fact, you can use it more than once, first to
f6c4c15febd7 (File Variables): Clarify previous change.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58861
diff changeset
1063 set the major mode and then to set minor modes which are specific to
f6c4c15febd7 (File Variables): Clarify previous change.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58861
diff changeset
1064 particular buffers. But most minor modes should not be specified in
f6c4c15febd7 (File Variables): Clarify previous change.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58861
diff changeset
1065 the file at all, regardless of how, because they represent user
f6c4c15febd7 (File Variables): Clarify previous change.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58861
diff changeset
1066 preferences.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1067
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1068 For example, you may be tempted to try to turn on Auto Fill mode with
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1069 a local variable list. That is a mistake. The choice of Auto Fill mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1070 or not is a matter of individual taste, not a matter of the contents of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1071 particular files. If you want to use Auto Fill, set up major mode hooks
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1072 with your @file{.emacs} file to turn it on (when appropriate) for you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1073 alone (@pxref{Init File}). Don't use a local variable list to impose
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1074 your taste on everyone.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1075
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1076 The start of the local variables list must be no more than 3000
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1077 characters from the end of the file, and must be in the last page if the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1078 file is divided into pages. Otherwise, Emacs will not notice it is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1079 there. The purpose of this rule is so that a stray @samp{Local
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1080 Variables:}@: not in the last page does not confuse Emacs, and so that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1081 visiting a long file that is all one page and has no local variables
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1082 list need not take the time to search the whole file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1083
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1084 Use the command @code{normal-mode} to reset the local variables and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1085 major mode of a buffer according to the file name and contents,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1086 including the local variables list if any. @xref{Choosing Modes}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1087
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1088 @findex enable-local-variables
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1089 The variable @code{enable-local-variables} controls whether to process
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1090 local variables in files, and thus gives you a chance to override them.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1091 Its default value is @code{t}, which means do process local variables in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1092 files. If you set the value to @code{nil}, Emacs simply ignores local
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1093 variables in files. Any other value says to query you about each file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1094 that has local variables, showing you the local variable specifications
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1095 so you can judge.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1096
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1097 @findex enable-local-eval
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1098 The @code{eval} ``variable,'' and certain actual variables, create a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1099 special risk; when you visit someone else's file, local variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1100 specifications for these could affect your Emacs in arbitrary ways.
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
1101 Therefore, the variable @code{enable-local-eval} controls whether Emacs
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1102 processes @code{eval} variables, as well variables with names that end
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1103 in @samp{-hook}, @samp{-hooks}, @samp{-function} or @samp{-functions},
59800
4a45f5c001b2 (Easy Customization): Defn of "User Option" now
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59353
diff changeset
1104 and certain other variables. The three possibilities for the variable's
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1105 value are @code{t}, @code{nil}, and anything else, just as for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1106 @code{enable-local-variables}. The default is @code{maybe}, which is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1107 neither @code{t} nor @code{nil}, so normally Emacs does ask for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1108 confirmation about file settings for these variables.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1109
54723
326aa7651bd6 (File Variables): Add safe-local-eval-forms.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 52979
diff changeset
1110 @findex safe-local-eval-forms
326aa7651bd6 (File Variables): Add safe-local-eval-forms.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 52979
diff changeset
1111 The @code{safe-local-eval-forms} is a customizable list of eval
326aa7651bd6 (File Variables): Add safe-local-eval-forms.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 52979
diff changeset
1112 forms which are safe to eval, so Emacs should not ask for
326aa7651bd6 (File Variables): Add safe-local-eval-forms.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 52979
diff changeset
1113 confirmation to evaluate these forms, even if
326aa7651bd6 (File Variables): Add safe-local-eval-forms.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 52979
diff changeset
1114 @code{enable-local-variables} says to ask for confirmation in general.
326aa7651bd6 (File Variables): Add safe-local-eval-forms.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents: 52979
diff changeset
1115
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1116 @node Key Bindings
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1117 @section Customizing Key Bindings
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1118 @cindex key bindings
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1119
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1120 This section describes @dfn{key bindings}, which map keys to commands,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1121 and @dfn{keymaps}, which record key bindings. It also explains how
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1122 to customize key bindings.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1123
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1124 Recall that a command is a Lisp function whose definition provides for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1125 interactive use. Like every Lisp function, a command has a function
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1126 name which usually consists of lower-case letters and hyphens.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1127
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1128 @menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1129 * Keymaps:: Generalities. The global keymap.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1130 * Prefix Keymaps:: Keymaps for prefix keys.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1131 * Local Keymaps:: Major and minor modes have their own keymaps.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1132 * Minibuffer Maps:: The minibuffer uses its own local keymaps.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1133 * Rebinding:: How to redefine one key's meaning conveniently.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1134 * Init Rebinding:: Rebinding keys with your init file, @file{.emacs}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1135 * Function Keys:: Rebinding terminal function keys.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1136 * Named ASCII Chars:: Distinguishing @key{TAB} from @kbd{C-i}, and so on.
52979
3649390c0f91 Replace @sc{ascii} and ASCII with @acronym{ASCII}.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 52401
diff changeset
1137 * Non-ASCII Rebinding:: Rebinding non-@acronym{ASCII} characters such as Latin-1.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1138 * Mouse Buttons:: Rebinding mouse buttons in Emacs.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1139 * Disabling:: Disabling a command means confirmation is required
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1140 before it can be executed. This is done to protect
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1141 beginners from surprises.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1142 @end menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1143
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1144 @node Keymaps
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1145 @subsection Keymaps
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1146 @cindex keymap
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1147
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1148 The bindings between key sequences and command functions are recorded
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1149 in data structures called @dfn{keymaps}. Emacs has many of these, each
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1150 used on particular occasions.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1151
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1152 Recall that a @dfn{key sequence} (@dfn{key}, for short) is a sequence
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1153 of @dfn{input events} that have a meaning as a unit. Input events
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1154 include characters, function keys and mouse buttons---all the inputs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1155 that you can send to the computer with your terminal. A key sequence
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1156 gets its meaning from its @dfn{binding}, which says what command it
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1157 runs. The function of keymaps is to record these bindings.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1158
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1159 @cindex global keymap
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1160 The @dfn{global} keymap is the most important keymap because it is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1161 always in effect. The global keymap defines keys for Fundamental mode;
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1162 most of these definitions are common to most or all major modes. Each
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1163 major or minor mode can have its own keymap which overrides the global
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1164 definitions of some keys.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1165
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1166 For example, a self-inserting character such as @kbd{g} is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1167 self-inserting because the global keymap binds it to the command
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1168 @code{self-insert-command}. The standard Emacs editing characters such
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1169 as @kbd{C-a} also get their standard meanings from the global keymap.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1170 Commands to rebind keys, such as @kbd{M-x global-set-key}, actually work
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1171 by storing the new binding in the proper place in the global map.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1172 @xref{Rebinding}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1173
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1174 Meta characters work differently; Emacs translates each Meta
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1175 character into a pair of characters starting with @key{ESC}. When you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1176 type the character @kbd{M-a} in a key sequence, Emacs replaces it with
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1177 @kbd{@key{ESC} a}. A meta key comes in as a single input event, but
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1178 becomes two events for purposes of key bindings. The reason for this is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1179 historical, and we might change it someday.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1180
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1181 @cindex function key
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1182 Most modern keyboards have function keys as well as character keys.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1183 Function keys send input events just as character keys do, and keymaps
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1184 can have bindings for them.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1185
59949
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
1186 On text terminals, typing a function key actually sends the computer a
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1187 sequence of characters; the precise details of the sequence depends on
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1188 which function key and on the model of terminal you are using. (Often
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1189 the sequence starts with @kbd{@key{ESC} [}.) If Emacs understands your
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1190 terminal type properly, it recognizes the character sequences forming
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1191 function keys wherever they occur in a key sequence (not just at the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1192 beginning). Thus, for most purposes, you can pretend the function keys
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1193 reach Emacs directly and ignore their encoding as character sequences.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1194
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1195 @cindex mouse
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1196 Mouse buttons also produce input events. These events come with other
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1197 data---the window and position where you pressed or released the button,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1198 and a time stamp. But only the choice of button matters for key
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1199 bindings; the other data matters only if a command looks at it.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1200 (Commands designed for mouse invocation usually do look at the other
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1201 data.)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1202
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1203 A keymap records definitions for single events. Interpreting a key
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1204 sequence of multiple events involves a chain of keymaps. The first
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1205 keymap gives a definition for the first event; this definition is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1206 another keymap, which is used to look up the second event in the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1207 sequence, and so on.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1208
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1209 Key sequences can mix function keys and characters. For example,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1210 @kbd{C-x @key{SELECT}} is meaningful. If you make @key{SELECT} a prefix
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1211 key, then @kbd{@key{SELECT} C-n} makes sense. You can even mix mouse
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1212 events with keyboard events, but we recommend against it, because such
37419
201fa171a6e2 Explain binding TAB etc using \t etc.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37354
diff changeset
1213 key sequences are inconvenient to use.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1214
37419
201fa171a6e2 Explain binding TAB etc using \t etc.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37354
diff changeset
1215 As a user, you can redefine any key; but it is usually best to stick
44783
c00838d6756f Explain C-c LETTER better.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44278
diff changeset
1216 to key sequences that consist of @kbd{C-c} followed by a letter (upper
c00838d6756f Explain C-c LETTER better.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44278
diff changeset
1217 or lower case). These keys are ``reserved for users,'' so they won't
c00838d6756f Explain C-c LETTER better.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44278
diff changeset
1218 conflict with any properly designed Emacs extension. The function
c00838d6756f Explain C-c LETTER better.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44278
diff changeset
1219 keys @key{F5} through @key{F9} are also reserved for users. If you
c00838d6756f Explain C-c LETTER better.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44278
diff changeset
1220 redefine some other key, your definition may be overridden by certain
c00838d6756f Explain C-c LETTER better.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 44278
diff changeset
1221 extensions or major modes which redefine the same key.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1222
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1223 @node Prefix Keymaps
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1224 @subsection Prefix Keymaps
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1225
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1226 A prefix key such as @kbd{C-x} or @key{ESC} has its own keymap,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1227 which holds the definition for the event that immediately follows
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1228 that prefix.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1229
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1230 The definition of a prefix key is usually the keymap to use for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1231 looking up the following event. The definition can also be a Lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1232 symbol whose function definition is the following keymap; the effect is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1233 the same, but it provides a command name for the prefix key that can be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1234 used as a description of what the prefix key is for. Thus, the binding
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1235 of @kbd{C-x} is the symbol @code{Ctl-X-Prefix}, whose function
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1236 definition is the keymap for @kbd{C-x} commands. The definitions of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1237 @kbd{C-c}, @kbd{C-x}, @kbd{C-h} and @key{ESC} as prefix keys appear in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1238 the global map, so these prefix keys are always available.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1239
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1240 Aside from ordinary prefix keys, there is a fictitious ``prefix key''
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1241 which represents the menu bar; see @ref{Menu Bar,,,elisp, The Emacs Lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1242 Reference Manual}, for special information about menu bar key bindings.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1243 Mouse button events that invoke pop-up menus are also prefix keys; see
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1244 @ref{Menu Keymaps,,,elisp, The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}, for more
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1245 details.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1246
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1247 Some prefix keymaps are stored in variables with names:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1248
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1249 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1250 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1251 @vindex ctl-x-map
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1252 @code{ctl-x-map} is the variable name for the map used for characters that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1253 follow @kbd{C-x}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1254 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1255 @vindex help-map
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1256 @code{help-map} is for characters that follow @kbd{C-h}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1257 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1258 @vindex esc-map
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1259 @code{esc-map} is for characters that follow @key{ESC}. Thus, all Meta
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1260 characters are actually defined by this map.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1261 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1262 @vindex ctl-x-4-map
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1263 @code{ctl-x-4-map} is for characters that follow @kbd{C-x 4}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1264 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1265 @vindex mode-specific-map
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1266 @code{mode-specific-map} is for characters that follow @kbd{C-c}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1267 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1268
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1269 @node Local Keymaps
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1270 @subsection Local Keymaps
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1271
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1272 @cindex local keymap
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1273 So far we have explained the ins and outs of the global map. Major
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1274 modes customize Emacs by providing their own key bindings in @dfn{local
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1275 keymaps}. For example, C mode overrides @key{TAB} to make it indent the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1276 current line for C code. Portions of text in the buffer can specify
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1277 their own keymaps to substitute for the keymap of the buffer's major
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1278 mode.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1279
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1280 @cindex minor mode keymap
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1281 Minor modes can also have local keymaps. Whenever a minor mode is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1282 in effect, the definitions in its keymap override both the major
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1283 mode's local keymap and the global keymap.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1284
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1285 @vindex c-mode-map
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1286 @vindex lisp-mode-map
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1287 The local keymaps for Lisp mode and several other major modes always
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1288 exist even when not in use. These are kept in variables named
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1289 @code{lisp-mode-map} and so on. For major modes less often used, the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1290 local keymap is normally constructed only when the mode is used for the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1291 first time in a session. This is to save space. If you wish to change
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1292 one of these keymaps, you must use the major mode's @dfn{mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1293 hook}---see below.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1294
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1295 All minor mode keymaps are created in advance. There is no way to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1296 defer their creation until the first time the minor mode is enabled.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1297
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1298 A local keymap can locally redefine a key as a prefix key by defining
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1299 it as a prefix keymap. If the key is also defined globally as a prefix,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1300 then its local and global definitions (both keymaps) effectively
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1301 combine: both of them are used to look up the event that follows the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1302 prefix key. Thus, if the mode's local keymap defines @kbd{C-c} as
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1303 another keymap, and that keymap defines @kbd{C-z} as a command, this
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1304 provides a local meaning for @kbd{C-c C-z}. This does not affect other
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1305 sequences that start with @kbd{C-c}; if those sequences don't have their
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1306 own local bindings, their global bindings remain in effect.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1307
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1308 Another way to think of this is that Emacs handles a multi-event key
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1309 sequence by looking in several keymaps, one by one, for a binding of the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1310 whole key sequence. First it checks the minor mode keymaps for minor
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1311 modes that are enabled, then it checks the major mode's keymap, and then
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1312 it checks the global keymap. This is not precisely how key lookup
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1313 works, but it's good enough for understanding ordinary circumstances.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1314
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1315 @cindex rebinding major mode keys
26392
b3d3ff9a7a2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1316 @findex define-key
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1317 To change the local bindings of a major mode, you must change the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1318 mode's local keymap. Normally you must wait until the first time the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1319 mode is used, because most major modes don't create their keymaps until
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1320 then. If you want to specify something in your @file{~/.emacs} file to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1321 change a major mode's bindings, you must use the mode's mode hook to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1322 delay the change until the mode is first used.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1323
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1324 For example, the command @code{texinfo-mode} to select Texinfo mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1325 runs the hook @code{texinfo-mode-hook}. Here's how you can use the hook
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1326 to add local bindings (not very useful, we admit) for @kbd{C-c n} and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1327 @kbd{C-c p} in Texinfo mode:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1328
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1329 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1330 (add-hook 'texinfo-mode-hook
36148
a2719b6e7a2f Don't use naked lambdas in examples. Fix bad @xref usage.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35188
diff changeset
1331 '(lambda ()
a2719b6e7a2f Don't use naked lambdas in examples. Fix bad @xref usage.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35188
diff changeset
1332 (define-key texinfo-mode-map "\C-cp"
a2719b6e7a2f Don't use naked lambdas in examples. Fix bad @xref usage.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35188
diff changeset
1333 'backward-paragraph)
a2719b6e7a2f Don't use naked lambdas in examples. Fix bad @xref usage.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35188
diff changeset
1334 (define-key texinfo-mode-map "\C-cn"
a2719b6e7a2f Don't use naked lambdas in examples. Fix bad @xref usage.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35188
diff changeset
1335 'forward-paragraph)))
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1336 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1337
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1338 @xref{Hooks}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1339
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1340 @node Minibuffer Maps
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1341 @subsection Minibuffer Keymaps
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1342
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1343 @cindex minibuffer keymaps
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1344 @vindex minibuffer-local-map
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1345 @vindex minibuffer-local-ns-map
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1346 @vindex minibuffer-local-completion-map
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1347 @vindex minibuffer-local-must-match-map
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1348 The minibuffer has its own set of local keymaps; they contain various
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1349 completion and exit commands.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1350
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1351 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1352 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1353 @code{minibuffer-local-map} is used for ordinary input (no completion).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1354 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1355 @code{minibuffer-local-ns-map} is similar, except that @key{SPC} exits
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1356 just like @key{RET}. This is used mainly for Mocklisp compatibility.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1357 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1358 @code{minibuffer-local-completion-map} is for permissive completion.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1359 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1360 @code{minibuffer-local-must-match-map} is for strict completion and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1361 for cautious completion.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1362 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1363
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1364 @node Rebinding
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1365 @subsection Changing Key Bindings Interactively
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1366 @cindex key rebinding, this session
36263
11db0318031d Remove redundant index entries.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36148
diff changeset
1367 @cindex redefining keys, this session
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1368
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1369 The way to redefine an Emacs key is to change its entry in a keymap.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1370 You can change the global keymap, in which case the change is effective in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1371 all major modes (except those that have their own overriding local
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1372 definitions for the same key). Or you can change the current buffer's
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1373 local map, which affects all buffers using the same major mode.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1374
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1375 @findex global-set-key
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1376 @findex local-set-key
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1377 @findex global-unset-key
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1378 @findex local-unset-key
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1379 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1380 @item M-x global-set-key @key{RET} @var{key} @var{cmd} @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1381 Define @var{key} globally to run @var{cmd}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1382 @item M-x local-set-key @key{RET} @var{key} @var{cmd} @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1383 Define @var{key} locally (in the major mode now in effect) to run
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1384 @var{cmd}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1385 @item M-x global-unset-key @key{RET} @var{key}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1386 Make @var{key} undefined in the global map.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1387 @item M-x local-unset-key @key{RET} @var{key}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1388 Make @var{key} undefined locally (in the major mode now in effect).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1389 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1390
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1391 For example, suppose you like to execute commands in a subshell within
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1392 an Emacs buffer, instead of suspending Emacs and executing commands in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1393 your login shell. Normally, @kbd{C-z} is bound to the function
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1394 @code{suspend-emacs} (when not using the X Window System), but you can
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1395 change @kbd{C-z} to invoke an interactive subshell within Emacs, by
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1396 binding it to @code{shell} as follows:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1397
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1398 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1399 M-x global-set-key @key{RET} C-z shell @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1400 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1401
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1402 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1403 @code{global-set-key} reads the command name after the key. After you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1404 press the key, a message like this appears so that you can confirm that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1405 you are binding the key you want:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1406
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1407 @example
49600
23a1cea22d13 Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 47535
diff changeset
1408 Set key C-z to command:
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1409 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1410
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1411 You can redefine function keys and mouse events in the same way; just
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1412 type the function key or click the mouse when it's time to specify the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1413 key to rebind.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1414
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1415 You can rebind a key that contains more than one event in the same
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1416 way. Emacs keeps reading the key to rebind until it is a complete key
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1417 (that is, not a prefix key). Thus, if you type @kbd{C-f} for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1418 @var{key}, that's the end; the minibuffer is entered immediately to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1419 read @var{cmd}. But if you type @kbd{C-x}, another character is read;
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1420 if that is @kbd{4}, another character is read, and so on. For
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1421 example,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1422
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1423 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1424 M-x global-set-key @key{RET} C-x 4 $ spell-other-window @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1425 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1426
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1427 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1428 redefines @kbd{C-x 4 $} to run the (fictitious) command
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1429 @code{spell-other-window}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1430
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1431 The two-character keys consisting of @kbd{C-c} followed by a letter
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1432 are reserved for user customizations. Lisp programs are not supposed to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1433 define these keys, so the bindings you make for them will be available
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1434 in all major modes and will never get in the way of anything.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1435
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1436 You can remove the global definition of a key with
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1437 @code{global-unset-key}. This makes the key @dfn{undefined}; if you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1438 type it, Emacs will just beep. Similarly, @code{local-unset-key} makes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1439 a key undefined in the current major mode keymap, which makes the global
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1440 definition (or lack of one) come back into effect in that major mode.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1441
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1442 If you have redefined (or undefined) a key and you subsequently wish
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1443 to retract the change, undefining the key will not do the job---you need
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1444 to redefine the key with its standard definition. To find the name of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1445 the standard definition of a key, go to a Fundamental mode buffer and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1446 use @kbd{C-h c}. The documentation of keys in this manual also lists
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1447 their command names.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1448
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1449 If you want to prevent yourself from invoking a command by mistake, it
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1450 is better to disable the command than to undefine the key. A disabled
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1451 command is less work to invoke when you really want to.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1452 @xref{Disabling}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1453
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1454 @node Init Rebinding
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1455 @subsection Rebinding Keys in Your Init File
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1456
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1457 If you have a set of key bindings that you like to use all the time,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1458 you can specify them in your @file{.emacs} file by using their Lisp
26392
b3d3ff9a7a2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1459 syntax. (@xref{Init File}.)
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1460
52979
3649390c0f91 Replace @sc{ascii} and ASCII with @acronym{ASCII}.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 52401
diff changeset
1461 The simplest method for doing this works for @acronym{ASCII} characters and
3649390c0f91 Replace @sc{ascii} and ASCII with @acronym{ASCII}.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 52401
diff changeset
1462 Meta-modified @acronym{ASCII} characters only. This method uses a string to
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1463 represent the key sequence you want to rebind. For example, here's how
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1464 to bind @kbd{C-z} to @code{shell}:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1465
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1466 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1467 (global-set-key "\C-z" 'shell)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1468 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1469
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1470 @noindent
59949
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
1471 This example uses a string constant containing one character,
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
1472 @kbd{C-z}. (@samp{\C-} is string syntax for a control character.) The
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
1473 single-quote before the command name, @code{shell}, marks it as a
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1474 constant symbol rather than a variable. If you omit the quote, Emacs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1475 would try to evaluate @code{shell} immediately as a variable. This
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1476 probably causes an error; it certainly isn't what you want.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1477
59949
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
1478 Here is another example that binds the key sequence @kbd{C-x M-l}:
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1479
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1480 @example
59949
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
1481 (global-set-key "\C-x\M-l" 'make-symbolic-link)
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1482 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1483
37419
201fa171a6e2 Explain binding TAB etc using \t etc.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37354
diff changeset
1484 To put @key{TAB}, @key{RET}, @key{ESC}, or @key{DEL} in the
201fa171a6e2 Explain binding TAB etc using \t etc.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37354
diff changeset
1485 string, you can use the Emacs Lisp escape sequences, @samp{\t},
201fa171a6e2 Explain binding TAB etc using \t etc.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37354
diff changeset
1486 @samp{\r}, @samp{\e}, and @samp{\d}. Here is an example which binds
201fa171a6e2 Explain binding TAB etc using \t etc.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37354
diff changeset
1487 @kbd{C-x @key{TAB}}:
201fa171a6e2 Explain binding TAB etc using \t etc.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37354
diff changeset
1488
201fa171a6e2 Explain binding TAB etc using \t etc.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37354
diff changeset
1489 @example
201fa171a6e2 Explain binding TAB etc using \t etc.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37354
diff changeset
1490 (global-set-key "\C-x\t" 'indent-rigidly)
201fa171a6e2 Explain binding TAB etc using \t etc.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37354
diff changeset
1491 @end example
201fa171a6e2 Explain binding TAB etc using \t etc.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37354
diff changeset
1492
52979
3649390c0f91 Replace @sc{ascii} and ASCII with @acronym{ASCII}.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 52401
diff changeset
1493 These examples show how to write some other special @acronym{ASCII} characters
39161
10b97dddcb68 Show how to put more special ASCII characters
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 39060
diff changeset
1494 in strings for key bindings:
10b97dddcb68 Show how to put more special ASCII characters
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 39060
diff changeset
1495
10b97dddcb68 Show how to put more special ASCII characters
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 39060
diff changeset
1496 @example
10b97dddcb68 Show how to put more special ASCII characters
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 39060
diff changeset
1497 (global-set-key "\r" 'newline) ;; @key{RET}
10b97dddcb68 Show how to put more special ASCII characters
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 39060
diff changeset
1498 (global-set-key "\d" 'delete-backward-char) ;; @key{DEL}
10b97dddcb68 Show how to put more special ASCII characters
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 39060
diff changeset
1499 (global-set-key "\C-x\e\e" 'repeat-complex-command) ;; @key{ESC}
10b97dddcb68 Show how to put more special ASCII characters
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 39060
diff changeset
1500 @end example
10b97dddcb68 Show how to put more special ASCII characters
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 39060
diff changeset
1501
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1502 When the key sequence includes function keys or mouse button events,
52979
3649390c0f91 Replace @sc{ascii} and ASCII with @acronym{ASCII}.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 52401
diff changeset
1503 or non-@acronym{ASCII} characters such as @code{C-=} or @code{H-a}, you must use
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1504 the more general method of rebinding, which uses a vector to specify the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1505 key sequence.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1506
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1507 The way to write a vector in Emacs Lisp is with square brackets around
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1508 the vector elements. Use spaces to separate the elements. If an
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1509 element is a symbol, simply write the symbol's name---no other
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1510 delimiters or punctuation are needed. If a vector element is a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1511 character, write it as a Lisp character constant: @samp{?} followed by
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1512 the character as it would appear in a string.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1513
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1514 Here are examples of using vectors to rebind @kbd{C-=} (a control
52979
3649390c0f91 Replace @sc{ascii} and ASCII with @acronym{ASCII}.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 52401
diff changeset
1515 character not in @acronym{ASCII}), @kbd{C-M-=} (not in @acronym{ASCII} because @kbd{C-=}
3649390c0f91 Replace @sc{ascii} and ASCII with @acronym{ASCII}.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 52401
diff changeset
1516 is not), @kbd{H-a} (a Hyper character; @acronym{ASCII} doesn't have Hyper at
38744
d7121931b3ba Show example of specifying C-M-= in Lisp.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38605
diff changeset
1517 all), @key{F7} (a function key), and @kbd{C-Mouse-1} (a
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1518 keyboard-modified mouse button):
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1519
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1520 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1521 (global-set-key [?\C-=] 'make-symbolic-link)
38744
d7121931b3ba Show example of specifying C-M-= in Lisp.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38605
diff changeset
1522 (global-set-key [?\M-\C-=] 'make-symbolic-link)
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1523 (global-set-key [?\H-a] 'make-symbolic-link)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1524 (global-set-key [f7] 'make-symbolic-link)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1525 (global-set-key [C-mouse-1] 'make-symbolic-link)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1526 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1527
39161
10b97dddcb68 Show how to put more special ASCII characters
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 39060
diff changeset
1528 You can use a vector for the simple cases too. Here's how to
59949
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
1529 rewrite the first six examples above to use vectors:
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1530
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1531 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1532 (global-set-key [?\C-z] 'shell)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1533 (global-set-key [?\C-x ?l] 'make-symbolic-link)
37419
201fa171a6e2 Explain binding TAB etc using \t etc.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37354
diff changeset
1534 (global-set-key [?\C-x ?\t] 'indent-rigidly)
39161
10b97dddcb68 Show how to put more special ASCII characters
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 39060
diff changeset
1535 (global-set-key [?\r] 'newline)
10b97dddcb68 Show how to put more special ASCII characters
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 39060
diff changeset
1536 (global-set-key [?\d] 'delete-backward-char)
10b97dddcb68 Show how to put more special ASCII characters
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 39060
diff changeset
1537 (global-set-key [?\C-x ?\e ?\e] 'repeat-complex-command)
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1538 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1539
39161
10b97dddcb68 Show how to put more special ASCII characters
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 39060
diff changeset
1540 @noindent
10b97dddcb68 Show how to put more special ASCII characters
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 39060
diff changeset
1541 As you see, you represent a multi-character key sequence with a vector
59949
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
1542 by listing all of the characters in order within the square brackets that
39161
10b97dddcb68 Show how to put more special ASCII characters
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 39060
diff changeset
1543 delimit the vector.
10b97dddcb68 Show how to put more special ASCII characters
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 39060
diff changeset
1544
51448
596b12c24475 (Init Rebinding): Replace previous change with xref.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51274
diff changeset
1545 Language and coding systems can cause problems with key bindings
52979
3649390c0f91 Replace @sc{ascii} and ASCII with @acronym{ASCII}.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 52401
diff changeset
1546 for non-@acronym{ASCII} characters. @xref{Non-ASCII Rebinding}.
51274
78a8be5d896c (Init Rebinding): Xref Non-ASCII Rebinding, for
Kai Großjohann <kgrossjo@eu.uu.net>
parents: 50696
diff changeset
1547
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1548 @node Function Keys
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1549 @subsection Rebinding Function Keys
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1550
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1551 Key sequences can contain function keys as well as ordinary
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1552 characters. Just as Lisp characters (actually integers) represent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1553 keyboard characters, Lisp symbols represent function keys. If the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1554 function key has a word as its label, then that word is also the name of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1555 the corresponding Lisp symbol. Here are the conventional Lisp names for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1556 common function keys:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1557
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1558 @table @asis
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1559 @item @code{left}, @code{up}, @code{right}, @code{down}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1560 Cursor arrow keys.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1561
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1562 @item @code{begin}, @code{end}, @code{home}, @code{next}, @code{prior}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1563 Other cursor repositioning keys.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1564
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1565 @item @code{select}, @code{print}, @code{execute}, @code{backtab}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1566 @itemx @code{insert}, @code{undo}, @code{redo}, @code{clearline}
37977
5ff6cac52888 Update Customization buffer examples
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37976
diff changeset
1567 @itemx @code{insertline}, @code{deleteline}, @code{insertchar}, @code{deletechar}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1568 Miscellaneous function keys.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1569
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1570 @item @code{f1}, @code{f2}, @dots{} @code{f35}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1571 Numbered function keys (across the top of the keyboard).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1572
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1573 @item @code{kp-add}, @code{kp-subtract}, @code{kp-multiply}, @code{kp-divide}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1574 @itemx @code{kp-backtab}, @code{kp-space}, @code{kp-tab}, @code{kp-enter}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1575 @itemx @code{kp-separator}, @code{kp-decimal}, @code{kp-equal}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1576 Keypad keys (to the right of the regular keyboard), with names or punctuation.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1577
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1578 @item @code{kp-0}, @code{kp-1}, @dots{} @code{kp-9}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1579 Keypad keys with digits.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1580
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1581 @item @code{kp-f1}, @code{kp-f2}, @code{kp-f3}, @code{kp-f4}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1582 Keypad PF keys.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1583 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1584
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1585 These names are conventional, but some systems (especially when using
35188
94d46968a93f Don't say "X Windows". From Colin Walters <walters@cis.ohio-state.edu>.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 34151
diff changeset
1586 X) may use different names. To make certain what symbol is used for a
94d46968a93f Don't say "X Windows". From Colin Walters <walters@cis.ohio-state.edu>.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 34151
diff changeset
1587 given function key on your terminal, type @kbd{C-h c} followed by that
94d46968a93f Don't say "X Windows". From Colin Walters <walters@cis.ohio-state.edu>.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 34151
diff changeset
1588 key.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1589
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1590 A key sequence which contains function key symbols (or anything but
59949
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
1591 @acronym{ASCII} characters) must be a vector rather than a string.
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
1592 Thus, to bind function key @samp{f1} to the command @code{rmail},
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
1593 write the following:
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1594
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1595 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1596 (global-set-key [f1] 'rmail)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1597 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1598
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1599 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1600 To bind the right-arrow key to the command @code{forward-char}, you can
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1601 use this expression:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1602
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1603 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1604 (global-set-key [right] 'forward-char)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1605 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1606
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1607 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1608 This uses the Lisp syntax for a vector containing the symbol
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1609 @code{right}. (This binding is present in Emacs by default.)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1610
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1611 @xref{Init Rebinding}, for more information about using vectors for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1612 rebinding.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1613
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1614 You can mix function keys and characters in a key sequence. This
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1615 example binds @kbd{C-x @key{NEXT}} to the command @code{forward-page}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1616
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1617 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1618 (global-set-key [?\C-x next] 'forward-page)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1619 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1620
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1621 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1622 where @code{?\C-x} is the Lisp character constant for the character
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1623 @kbd{C-x}. The vector element @code{next} is a symbol and therefore
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1624 does not take a question mark.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1625
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1626 You can use the modifier keys @key{CTRL}, @key{META}, @key{HYPER},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1627 @key{SUPER}, @key{ALT} and @key{SHIFT} with function keys. To represent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1628 these modifiers, add the strings @samp{C-}, @samp{M-}, @samp{H-},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1629 @samp{s-}, @samp{A-} and @samp{S-} at the front of the symbol name.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1630 Thus, here is how to make @kbd{Hyper-Meta-@key{RIGHT}} move forward a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1631 word:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1632
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1633 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1634 (global-set-key [H-M-right] 'forward-word)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1635 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1636
61051
a45405053cb1 (Function Keys): Document kp- event types and keypad-setup package.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 60423
diff changeset
1637 @cindex keypad
a45405053cb1 (Function Keys): Document kp- event types and keypad-setup package.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 60423
diff changeset
1638 Many keyboards have a ``numeric keypad'' on the right hand side.
a45405053cb1 (Function Keys): Document kp- event types and keypad-setup package.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 60423
diff changeset
1639 The numeric keys in the keypad double up as cursor motion keys,
a45405053cb1 (Function Keys): Document kp- event types and keypad-setup package.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 60423
diff changeset
1640 toggled by a key labelled @samp{Num Lock}. By default, Emacs
a45405053cb1 (Function Keys): Document kp- event types and keypad-setup package.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 60423
diff changeset
1641 translates these keys to the corresponding keys in the main keyboard
a45405053cb1 (Function Keys): Document kp- event types and keypad-setup package.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 60423
diff changeset
1642 (@pxref{Keyboard Translations}). For example, when @samp{Num Lock} is
a45405053cb1 (Function Keys): Document kp- event types and keypad-setup package.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 60423
diff changeset
1643 on, the key labelled @samp{8} on the numeric keypad produces
a45405053cb1 (Function Keys): Document kp- event types and keypad-setup package.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 60423
diff changeset
1644 @code{kp-8}, which is translated to @kbd{8}; when @samp{Num Lock} is
a45405053cb1 (Function Keys): Document kp- event types and keypad-setup package.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 60423
diff changeset
1645 off, the same key produces @code{kp-up}, which is translated to
a45405053cb1 (Function Keys): Document kp- event types and keypad-setup package.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 60423
diff changeset
1646 @key{UP}. If you rebind a key such as @kbd{8} or @key{UP}, it affects
a45405053cb1 (Function Keys): Document kp- event types and keypad-setup package.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 60423
diff changeset
1647 the equivalent keypad key too. However, if you rebind a @samp{kp-}
a45405053cb1 (Function Keys): Document kp- event types and keypad-setup package.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 60423
diff changeset
1648 key directly, that won't affect its non-keypad equivalent.
a45405053cb1 (Function Keys): Document kp- event types and keypad-setup package.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 60423
diff changeset
1649
a45405053cb1 (Function Keys): Document kp- event types and keypad-setup package.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 60423
diff changeset
1650 Emacs provides a convenient method for binding the numeric keypad
a45405053cb1 (Function Keys): Document kp- event types and keypad-setup package.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 60423
diff changeset
1651 keys, using the variables @code{keypad-setup},
a45405053cb1 (Function Keys): Document kp- event types and keypad-setup package.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 60423
diff changeset
1652 @code{keypad-numlock-setup}, @code{keypad-shifted-setup}, and
a45405053cb1 (Function Keys): Document kp- event types and keypad-setup package.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 60423
diff changeset
1653 @code{keypad-numlock-shifted-setup}. These can be found in the
a45405053cb1 (Function Keys): Document kp- event types and keypad-setup package.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 60423
diff changeset
1654 @samp{keyboard} customization group (@pxref{Easy Customization}). You
a45405053cb1 (Function Keys): Document kp- event types and keypad-setup package.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 60423
diff changeset
1655 can rebind the keys to perform other tasks, such as issuing numeric
a45405053cb1 (Function Keys): Document kp- event types and keypad-setup package.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 60423
diff changeset
1656 prefix arguments.
a45405053cb1 (Function Keys): Document kp- event types and keypad-setup package.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 60423
diff changeset
1657
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1658 @node Named ASCII Chars
52979
3649390c0f91 Replace @sc{ascii} and ASCII with @acronym{ASCII}.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 52401
diff changeset
1659 @subsection Named @acronym{ASCII} Control Characters
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1660
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1661 @key{TAB}, @key{RET}, @key{BS}, @key{LFD}, @key{ESC} and @key{DEL}
59949
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
1662 started out as names for certain @acronym{ASCII} control characters,
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
1663 used so often that they have special keys of their own. For instance,
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
1664 @key{TAB} was another name for @kbd{C-i}. Later, users found it
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1665 convenient to distinguish in Emacs between these keys and the ``same''
59949
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
1666 control characters typed with the @key{CTRL} key. Therefore, on most
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
1667 modern terminals, they are no longer the same, and @key{TAB} is
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
1668 distinguishable from @kbd{C-i}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1669
59949
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
1670 Emacs can distinguish these two kinds of input if the keyboard does.
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
1671 It treats the ``special'' keys as function keys named @code{tab},
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
1672 @code{return}, @code{backspace}, @code{linefeed}, @code{escape}, and
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
1673 @code{delete}. These function keys translate automatically into the
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
1674 corresponding @acronym{ASCII} characters @emph{if} they have no
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
1675 bindings of their own. As a result, neither users nor Lisp programs
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
1676 need to pay attention to the distinction unless they care to.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1677
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1678 If you do not want to distinguish between (for example) @key{TAB} and
52979
3649390c0f91 Replace @sc{ascii} and ASCII with @acronym{ASCII}.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 52401
diff changeset
1679 @kbd{C-i}, make just one binding, for the @acronym{ASCII} character @key{TAB}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1680 (octal code 011). If you do want to distinguish, make one binding for
52979
3649390c0f91 Replace @sc{ascii} and ASCII with @acronym{ASCII}.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 52401
diff changeset
1681 this @acronym{ASCII} character, and another for the ``function key'' @code{tab}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1682
52979
3649390c0f91 Replace @sc{ascii} and ASCII with @acronym{ASCII}.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 52401
diff changeset
1683 With an ordinary @acronym{ASCII} terminal, there is no way to distinguish
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1684 between @key{TAB} and @kbd{C-i} (and likewise for other such pairs),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1685 because the terminal sends the same character in both cases.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1686
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1687 @node Non-ASCII Rebinding
52979
3649390c0f91 Replace @sc{ascii} and ASCII with @acronym{ASCII}.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 52401
diff changeset
1688 @subsection Non-@acronym{ASCII} Characters on the Keyboard
3649390c0f91 Replace @sc{ascii} and ASCII with @acronym{ASCII}.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 52401
diff changeset
1689 @cindex rebinding non-@acronym{ASCII} keys
3649390c0f91 Replace @sc{ascii} and ASCII with @acronym{ASCII}.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 52401
diff changeset
1690 @cindex non-@acronym{ASCII} keys, binding
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1691
56690
d699954ad4c6 (Non-ASCII Rebinding):
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56165
diff changeset
1692 If your keyboard has keys that send non-@acronym{ASCII}
d699954ad4c6 (Non-ASCII Rebinding):
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56165
diff changeset
1693 characters, such as accented letters, rebinding these keys
d699954ad4c6 (Non-ASCII Rebinding):
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56165
diff changeset
1694 must be done by using a vector like this@footnote{Note that
d699954ad4c6 (Non-ASCII Rebinding):
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56165
diff changeset
1695 you should avoid the string syntax for binding
d699954ad4c6 (Non-ASCII Rebinding):
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56165
diff changeset
1696 non-@acronym{ASCII} characters, since they will be
d699954ad4c6 (Non-ASCII Rebinding):
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56165
diff changeset
1697 interpreted as meta keys. @xref{Strings of Events,,,elisp,
d699954ad4c6 (Non-ASCII Rebinding):
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56165
diff changeset
1698 The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}.}:
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1699
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1700 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1701 (global-set-key [?@var{char}] 'some-function)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1702 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1703
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1704 @noindent
36632
1bfc2fad762a (File Variables): Fix a typo.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36593
diff changeset
1705 Type @kbd{C-q} followed by the key you want to bind, to insert @var{char}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1706
56690
d699954ad4c6 (Non-ASCII Rebinding):
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56165
diff changeset
1707 Since this puts a non-@acronym{ASCII} character in the @file{.emacs},
57156
a830d2693f6e (Hooks): Explain using setq to clear out a hook.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56785
diff changeset
1708 you should specify a coding system for that file that supports the
a830d2693f6e (Hooks): Explain using setq to clear out a hook.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56785
diff changeset
1709 character in question. @xref{Init Syntax}.
51448
596b12c24475 (Init Rebinding): Replace previous change with xref.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 51274
diff changeset
1710
57156
a830d2693f6e (Hooks): Explain using setq to clear out a hook.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56785
diff changeset
1711 @strong{Warning:} if you change the keyboard encoding, or change
a830d2693f6e (Hooks): Explain using setq to clear out a hook.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56785
diff changeset
1712 between multibyte and unibyte mode, or anything that would alter which
a830d2693f6e (Hooks): Explain using setq to clear out a hook.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56785
diff changeset
1713 code @kbd{C-q} would insert for that character, you'll need to edit
a830d2693f6e (Hooks): Explain using setq to clear out a hook.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56785
diff changeset
1714 the Lisp expression accordingly, to use the character code generated
a830d2693f6e (Hooks): Explain using setq to clear out a hook.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56785
diff changeset
1715 by @kbd{C-q} in the new mode.
27218
ff77115434db Doc recent changes in Custom.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26392
diff changeset
1716
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1717 @node Mouse Buttons
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1718 @subsection Rebinding Mouse Buttons
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1719 @cindex mouse button events
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1720 @cindex rebinding mouse buttons
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1721 @cindex click events
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1722 @cindex drag events
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1723 @cindex down events
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1724 @cindex button down events
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1725
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1726 Emacs uses Lisp symbols to designate mouse buttons, too. The ordinary
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1727 mouse events in Emacs are @dfn{click} events; these happen when you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1728 press a button and release it without moving the mouse. You can also
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1729 get @dfn{drag} events, when you move the mouse while holding the button
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1730 down. Drag events happen when you finally let go of the button.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1731
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1732 The symbols for basic click events are @code{mouse-1} for the leftmost
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1733 button, @code{mouse-2} for the next, and so on. Here is how you can
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1734 redefine the second mouse button to split the current window:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1735
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1736 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1737 (global-set-key [mouse-2] 'split-window-vertically)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1738 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1739
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1740 The symbols for drag events are similar, but have the prefix
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1741 @samp{drag-} before the word @samp{mouse}. For example, dragging the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1742 first button generates a @code{drag-mouse-1} event.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1743
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1744 You can also define bindings for events that occur when a mouse button
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1745 is pressed down. These events start with @samp{down-} instead of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1746 @samp{drag-}. Such events are generated only if they have key bindings.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1747 When you get a button-down event, a corresponding click or drag event
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1748 will always follow.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1749
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1750 @cindex double clicks
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1751 @cindex triple clicks
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1752 If you wish, you can distinguish single, double, and triple clicks. A
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1753 double click means clicking a mouse button twice in approximately the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1754 same place. The first click generates an ordinary click event. The
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1755 second click, if it comes soon enough, generates a double-click event
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1756 instead. The event type for a double-click event starts with
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1757 @samp{double-}: for example, @code{double-mouse-3}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1758
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1759 This means that you can give a special meaning to the second click at
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1760 the same place, but it must act on the assumption that the ordinary
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1761 single click definition has run when the first click was received.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1762
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1763 This constrains what you can do with double clicks, but user interface
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1764 designers say that this constraint ought to be followed in any case. A
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1765 double click should do something similar to the single click, only
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1766 ``more so.'' The command for the double-click event should perform the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1767 extra work for the double click.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1768
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1769 If a double-click event has no binding, it changes to the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1770 corresponding single-click event. Thus, if you don't define a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1771 particular double click specially, it executes the single-click command
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1772 twice.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1773
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1774 Emacs also supports triple-click events whose names start with
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1775 @samp{triple-}. Emacs does not distinguish quadruple clicks as event
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1776 types; clicks beyond the third generate additional triple-click events.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1777 However, the full number of clicks is recorded in the event list, so you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1778 can distinguish if you really want to. We don't recommend distinct
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1779 meanings for more than three clicks, but sometimes it is useful for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1780 subsequent clicks to cycle through the same set of three meanings, so
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1781 that four clicks are equivalent to one click, five are equivalent to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1782 two, and six are equivalent to three.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1783
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1784 Emacs also records multiple presses in drag and button-down events.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1785 For example, when you press a button twice, then move the mouse while
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1786 holding the button, Emacs gets a @samp{double-drag-} event. And at the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1787 moment when you press it down for the second time, Emacs gets a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1788 @samp{double-down-} event (which is ignored, like all button-down
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1789 events, if it has no binding).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1790
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1791 @vindex double-click-time
38744
d7121931b3ba Show example of specifying C-M-= in Lisp.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38605
diff changeset
1792 The variable @code{double-click-time} specifies how much time can
d7121931b3ba Show example of specifying C-M-= in Lisp.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38605
diff changeset
1793 elapse between clicks and still allow them to be grouped as a multiple
d7121931b3ba Show example of specifying C-M-= in Lisp.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38605
diff changeset
1794 click. Its value is in units of milliseconds. If the value is
d7121931b3ba Show example of specifying C-M-= in Lisp.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38605
diff changeset
1795 @code{nil}, double clicks are not detected at all. If the value is
38771
3e5c99acf21a (Mouse Buttons): Document the default values for double-click-time
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38744
diff changeset
1796 @code{t}, then there is no time limit. The default is 500.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1797
38605
f99d2e5ee830 Add description of double-click-fuzz.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 38376
diff changeset
1798 @vindex double-click-fuzz
f99d2e5ee830 Add description of double-click-fuzz.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 38376
diff changeset
1799 The variable @code{double-click-fuzz} specifies how much the mouse
38744
d7121931b3ba Show example of specifying C-M-= in Lisp.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38605
diff changeset
1800 can move between clicks still allow them to be grouped as a multiple
39060
07afb71a874e (Mouse Buttons): Document the different units of double-click-fuzz
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38870
diff changeset
1801 click. Its value is in units of pixels on windowed displays and in
07afb71a874e (Mouse Buttons): Document the different units of double-click-fuzz
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38870
diff changeset
1802 units of 1/8 of a character cell on text-mode terminals; the default is
07afb71a874e (Mouse Buttons): Document the different units of double-click-fuzz
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38870
diff changeset
1803 3.
38605
f99d2e5ee830 Add description of double-click-fuzz.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 38376
diff changeset
1804
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1805 The symbols for mouse events also indicate the status of the modifier
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1806 keys, with the usual prefixes @samp{C-}, @samp{M-}, @samp{H-},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1807 @samp{s-}, @samp{A-} and @samp{S-}. These always precede @samp{double-}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1808 or @samp{triple-}, which always precede @samp{drag-} or @samp{down-}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1809
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1810 A frame includes areas that don't show text from the buffer, such as
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1811 the mode line and the scroll bar. You can tell whether a mouse button
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1812 comes from a special area of the screen by means of dummy ``prefix
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1813 keys.'' For example, if you click the mouse in the mode line, you get
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1814 the prefix key @code{mode-line} before the ordinary mouse-button symbol.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1815 Thus, here is how to define the command for clicking the first button in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1816 a mode line to run @code{scroll-up}:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1817
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1818 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1819 (global-set-key [mode-line mouse-1] 'scroll-up)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1820 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1821
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1822 Here is the complete list of these dummy prefix keys and their
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1823 meanings:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1824
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1825 @table @code
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1826 @item mode-line
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1827 The mouse was in the mode line of a window.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1828 @item vertical-line
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1829 The mouse was in the vertical line separating side-by-side windows. (If
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1830 you use scroll bars, they appear in place of these vertical lines.)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1831 @item vertical-scroll-bar
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1832 The mouse was in a vertical scroll bar. (This is the only kind of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1833 scroll bar Emacs currently supports.)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1834 @ignore
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1835 @item horizontal-scroll-bar
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1836 The mouse was in a horizontal scroll bar. Horizontal scroll bars do
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1837 horizontal scrolling, and people don't use them often.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1838 @end ignore
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1839 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1840
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1841 You can put more than one mouse button in a key sequence, but it isn't
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1842 usual to do so.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1843
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1844 @node Disabling
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1845 @subsection Disabling Commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1846 @cindex disabled command
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1847
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1848 Disabling a command marks the command as requiring confirmation before it
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1849 can be executed. The purpose of disabling a command is to prevent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1850 beginning users from executing it by accident and being confused.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1851
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1852 An attempt to invoke a disabled command interactively in Emacs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1853 displays a window containing the command's name, its documentation, and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1854 some instructions on what to do immediately; then Emacs asks for input
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1855 saying whether to execute the command as requested, enable it and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1856 execute it, or cancel. If you decide to enable the command, you are
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1857 asked whether to do this permanently or just for the current session.
37977
5ff6cac52888 Update Customization buffer examples
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37976
diff changeset
1858 (Enabling permanently works by automatically editing your @file{.emacs}
5ff6cac52888 Update Customization buffer examples
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37976
diff changeset
1859 file.) You can also type @kbd{!} to enable @emph{all} commands,
5ff6cac52888 Update Customization buffer examples
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37976
diff changeset
1860 for the current session only.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1861
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1862 The direct mechanism for disabling a command is to put a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1863 non-@code{nil} @code{disabled} property on the Lisp symbol for the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1864 command. Here is the Lisp program to do this:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1865
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1866 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1867 (put 'delete-region 'disabled t)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1868 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1869
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1870 If the value of the @code{disabled} property is a string, that string
38870
d44abb4e68b2 Don't use "print" for displaying a message.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38791
diff changeset
1871 is included in the message displayed when the command is used:
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1872
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1873 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1874 (put 'delete-region 'disabled
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1875 "It's better to use `kill-region' instead.\n")
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1876 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1877
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1878 @findex disable-command
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1879 @findex enable-command
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1880 You can make a command disabled either by editing the @file{.emacs}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1881 file directly or with the command @kbd{M-x disable-command}, which edits
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1882 the @file{.emacs} file for you. Likewise, @kbd{M-x enable-command}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1883 edits @file{.emacs} to enable a command permanently. @xref{Init File}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1884
43062
c9d1c7655c9f (Disabling): Document that .emacs is not edited from "emacs -q".
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43038
diff changeset
1885 If Emacs was invoked with the @option{-q} or @option{--no-init-file}
c9d1c7655c9f (Disabling): Document that .emacs is not edited from "emacs -q".
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43038
diff changeset
1886 options (@pxref{Initial Options}), it will not edit your
c9d1c7655c9f (Disabling): Document that .emacs is not edited from "emacs -q".
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43038
diff changeset
1887 @file{~/.emacs} init file. This is because editing the init file from
c9d1c7655c9f (Disabling): Document that .emacs is not edited from "emacs -q".
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43038
diff changeset
1888 such a session might overwrite the lines you might have on your init
c9d1c7655c9f (Disabling): Document that .emacs is not edited from "emacs -q".
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43038
diff changeset
1889 file which enable and disable commands.
c9d1c7655c9f (Disabling): Document that .emacs is not edited from "emacs -q".
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 43038
diff changeset
1890
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1891 Whether a command is disabled is independent of what key is used to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1892 invoke it; disabling also applies if the command is invoked using
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1893 @kbd{M-x}. Disabling a command has no effect on calling it as a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1894 function from Lisp programs.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1895
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1896 @node Keyboard Translations
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1897 @section Keyboard Translations
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1898
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1899 Some keyboards do not make it convenient to send all the special
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1900 characters that Emacs uses. The most common problem case is the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1901 @key{DEL} character. Some keyboards provide no convenient way to type
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1902 this very important character---usually because they were designed to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1903 expect the character @kbd{C-h} to be used for deletion. On these
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1904 keyboards, if you press the key normally used for deletion, Emacs handles
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1905 the @kbd{C-h} as a prefix character and offers you a list of help
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1906 options, which is not what you want.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1907
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1908 @cindex keyboard translations
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1909 @findex keyboard-translate
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1910 You can work around this problem within Emacs by setting up keyboard
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1911 translations to turn @kbd{C-h} into @key{DEL} and @key{DEL} into
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1912 @kbd{C-h}, as follows:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1913
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1914 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1915 ;; @r{Translate @kbd{C-h} to @key{DEL}.}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1916 (keyboard-translate ?\C-h ?\C-?)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1917
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1918 ;; @r{Translate @key{DEL} to @kbd{C-h}.}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1919 (keyboard-translate ?\C-? ?\C-h)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1920 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1921
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1922 Keyboard translations are not the same as key bindings in keymaps
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1923 (@pxref{Keymaps}). Emacs contains numerous keymaps that apply in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1924 different situations, but there is only one set of keyboard
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1925 translations, and it applies to every character that Emacs reads from
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1926 the terminal. Keyboard translations take place at the lowest level of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1927 input processing; the keys that are looked up in keymaps contain the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1928 characters that result from keyboard translation.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1929
36656
e562b27b8afd DELETE and BACSKPACE are supported on any window system, not only X.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36632
diff changeset
1930 On a window system, the keyboard key named @key{DELETE} is a function
52979
3649390c0f91 Replace @sc{ascii} and ASCII with @acronym{ASCII}.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 52401
diff changeset
1931 key and is distinct from the @acronym{ASCII} character named @key{DEL}.
3649390c0f91 Replace @sc{ascii} and ASCII with @acronym{ASCII}.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 52401
diff changeset
1932 @xref{Named ASCII Chars}. Keyboard translations affect only @acronym{ASCII}
36656
e562b27b8afd DELETE and BACSKPACE are supported on any window system, not only X.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36632
diff changeset
1933 character input, not function keys; thus, the above example used on a
e562b27b8afd DELETE and BACSKPACE are supported on any window system, not only X.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36632
diff changeset
1934 window system does not affect the @key{DELETE} key. However, the
e562b27b8afd DELETE and BACSKPACE are supported on any window system, not only X.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36632
diff changeset
1935 translation above isn't necessary on window systems, because Emacs can
e562b27b8afd DELETE and BACSKPACE are supported on any window system, not only X.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36632
diff changeset
1936 also distinguish between the @key{BACKSPACE} key and @kbd{C-h}; and it
e562b27b8afd DELETE and BACSKPACE are supported on any window system, not only X.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36632
diff changeset
1937 normally treats @key{BACKSPACE} as @key{DEL}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1938
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1939 For full information about how to use keyboard translations, see
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1940 @ref{Translating Input,,,elisp, The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1941
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1942 @node Syntax
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1943 @section The Syntax Table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1944 @cindex syntax table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1945
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1946 All the Emacs commands which parse words or balance parentheses are
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1947 controlled by the @dfn{syntax table}. The syntax table says which
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1948 characters are opening delimiters, which are parts of words, which are
37122
a34d1e2a580f Correct syntax table data structure. Other clarifications about
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36656
diff changeset
1949 string quotes, and so on. It does this by assigning each character to
a34d1e2a580f Correct syntax table data structure. Other clarifications about
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36656
diff changeset
1950 one of fifteen-odd @dfn{syntax classes}. In some cases it specifies
a34d1e2a580f Correct syntax table data structure. Other clarifications about
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36656
diff changeset
1951 some additional information also.
a34d1e2a580f Correct syntax table data structure. Other clarifications about
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36656
diff changeset
1952
38114
4face9462576 Minor clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37977
diff changeset
1953 Each major mode has its own syntax table (though related major modes
4face9462576 Minor clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37977
diff changeset
1954 sometimes share one syntax table) which it installs in each buffer
37122
a34d1e2a580f Correct syntax table data structure. Other clarifications about
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36656
diff changeset
1955 that uses the mode. The syntax table installed in the current buffer
a34d1e2a580f Correct syntax table data structure. Other clarifications about
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36656
diff changeset
1956 is the one that all commands use, so we call it ``the'' syntax table.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1957
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1958 @kindex C-h s
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1959 @findex describe-syntax
37122
a34d1e2a580f Correct syntax table data structure. Other clarifications about
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36656
diff changeset
1960 To display a description of the contents of the current syntax
a34d1e2a580f Correct syntax table data structure. Other clarifications about
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36656
diff changeset
1961 table, type @kbd{C-h s} (@code{describe-syntax}). The description of
a34d1e2a580f Correct syntax table data structure. Other clarifications about
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36656
diff changeset
1962 each character includes both the string you would have to give to
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1963 @code{modify-syntax-entry} to set up that character's current syntax,
37122
a34d1e2a580f Correct syntax table data structure. Other clarifications about
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36656
diff changeset
1964 starting with the character which designates its syntax class, plus
a34d1e2a580f Correct syntax table data structure. Other clarifications about
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36656
diff changeset
1965 some English text to explain its meaning.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1966
37122
a34d1e2a580f Correct syntax table data structure. Other clarifications about
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36656
diff changeset
1967 A syntax table is actually a Lisp object, a char-table, whose
a34d1e2a580f Correct syntax table data structure. Other clarifications about
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36656
diff changeset
1968 elements are cons cells. For full information on the syntax table,
a34d1e2a580f Correct syntax table data structure. Other clarifications about
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36656
diff changeset
1969 see @ref{Syntax Tables,, Syntax Tables, elisp, The Emacs Lisp
a34d1e2a580f Correct syntax table data structure. Other clarifications about
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36656
diff changeset
1970 Reference Manual}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1971
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1972 @node Init File
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1973 @section The Init File, @file{~/.emacs}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1974 @cindex init file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1975 @cindex Emacs initialization file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1976 @cindex key rebinding, permanent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1977 @cindex rebinding keys, permanently
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1978 @cindex startup (init file)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1979
59949
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
1980 When Emacs is started, it normally loads a Lisp program from the
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
1981 file @file{.emacs} or @file{.emacs.el} in your home directory. (You
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
1982 can also put it in a subdirectory @file{~/.emacs.d} and Emacs will
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
1983 still find it.) We call this file your @dfn{init file} because it
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
1984 specifies how to initialize Emacs for you. You can use the command
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
1985 line switch @samp{-q} to prevent loading your init file, and @samp{-u}
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
1986 (or @samp{--user}) to specify a different user's init file
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
1987 (@pxref{Initial Options}).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1988
37596
47f8d088e385 (Init File): Say explicitly that site-start.el is also searched along
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37581
diff changeset
1989 @cindex @file{default.el}, the default init file
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1990 There can also be a @dfn{default init file}, which is the library
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1991 named @file{default.el}, found via the standard search path for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1992 libraries. The Emacs distribution contains no such library; your site
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1993 may create one for local customizations. If this library exists, it is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1994 loaded whenever you start Emacs (except when you specify @samp{-q}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1995 But your init file, if any, is loaded first; if it sets
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1996 @code{inhibit-default-init} non-@code{nil}, then @file{default} is not
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1997 loaded.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1998
37596
47f8d088e385 (Init File): Say explicitly that site-start.el is also searched along
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37581
diff changeset
1999 @cindex site init file
47f8d088e385 (Init File): Say explicitly that site-start.el is also searched along
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37581
diff changeset
2000 @cindex @file{site-start.el}, the site startup file
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2001 Your site may also have a @dfn{site startup file}; this is named
37596
47f8d088e385 (Init File): Say explicitly that site-start.el is also searched along
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37581
diff changeset
2002 @file{site-start.el}, if it exists. Like @file{default.el}, Emacs
47f8d088e385 (Init File): Say explicitly that site-start.el is also searched along
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37581
diff changeset
2003 finds this file via the standard search path for Lisp libraries.
47f8d088e385 (Init File): Say explicitly that site-start.el is also searched along
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37581
diff changeset
2004 Emacs loads this library before it loads your init file. To inhibit
55834
a32af30ee1a1 (Init File): Two dashes start --no-site-file.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 54723
diff changeset
2005 loading of this library, use the option @samp{--no-site-file}.
37596
47f8d088e385 (Init File): Say explicitly that site-start.el is also searched along
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37581
diff changeset
2006 @xref{Initial Options}.
47f8d088e385 (Init File): Say explicitly that site-start.el is also searched along
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37581
diff changeset
2007
47f8d088e385 (Init File): Say explicitly that site-start.el is also searched along
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37581
diff changeset
2008 You can place @file{default.el} and @file{site-start.el} in any of
47f8d088e385 (Init File): Say explicitly that site-start.el is also searched along
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37581
diff changeset
2009 the directories which Emacs searches for Lisp libraries. The variable
47f8d088e385 (Init File): Say explicitly that site-start.el is also searched along
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37581
diff changeset
2010 @code{load-path} (@pxref{Lisp Libraries}) specifies these directories.
47f8d088e385 (Init File): Say explicitly that site-start.el is also searched along
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37581
diff changeset
2011 Many sites put these files in the @file{site-lisp} subdirectory of the
47f8d088e385 (Init File): Say explicitly that site-start.el is also searched along
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37581
diff changeset
2012 Emacs installation directory, typically
47f8d088e385 (Init File): Say explicitly that site-start.el is also searched along
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37581
diff changeset
2013 @file{/usr/local/share/emacs/site-lisp}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2014
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2015 If you have a large amount of code in your @file{.emacs} file, you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2016 should rename it to @file{~/.emacs.el}, and byte-compile it. @xref{Byte
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2017 Compilation,, Byte Compilation, elisp, the Emacs Lisp Reference Manual},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2018 for more information about compiling Emacs Lisp programs.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2019
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2020 If you are going to write actual Emacs Lisp programs that go beyond
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2021 minor customization, you should read the @cite{Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2022 @ifinfo
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2023 @xref{Top, Emacs Lisp, Emacs Lisp, elisp, the Emacs Lisp Reference
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2024 Manual}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2025 @end ifinfo
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2026
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2027 @menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2028 * Init Syntax:: Syntax of constants in Emacs Lisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2029 * Init Examples:: How to do some things with an init file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2030 * Terminal Init:: Each terminal type can have an init file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2031 * Find Init:: How Emacs finds the init file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2032 @end menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2033
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2034 @node Init Syntax
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2035 @subsection Init File Syntax
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2036
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2037 The @file{.emacs} file contains one or more Lisp function call
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2038 expressions. Each of these consists of a function name followed by
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2039 arguments, all surrounded by parentheses. For example, @code{(setq
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2040 fill-column 60)} calls the function @code{setq} to set the variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2041 @code{fill-column} (@pxref{Filling}) to 60.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2042
56085
e6cc673c5461 (Init Syntax): Explain about vars that do special
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 55834
diff changeset
2043 You can set any Lisp variable with @code{setq}, but with certain
e6cc673c5461 (Init Syntax): Explain about vars that do special
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 55834
diff changeset
2044 variables @code{setq} won't do what you probably want in the
e6cc673c5461 (Init Syntax): Explain about vars that do special
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 55834
diff changeset
2045 @file{.emacs} file. Some variables automatically become buffer-local
e6cc673c5461 (Init Syntax): Explain about vars that do special
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 55834
diff changeset
2046 when set with @code{setq}; what you want in @file{.emacs} is to set
e6cc673c5461 (Init Syntax): Explain about vars that do special
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 55834
diff changeset
2047 the default value, using @code{setq-default}. Some customizable minor
e6cc673c5461 (Init Syntax): Explain about vars that do special
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 55834
diff changeset
2048 mode variables do special things to enable the mode when you set them
e6cc673c5461 (Init Syntax): Explain about vars that do special
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 55834
diff changeset
2049 with Customize, but ordinary @code{setq} won't do that; to enable the
e6cc673c5461 (Init Syntax): Explain about vars that do special
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 55834
diff changeset
2050 mode in your @file{.emacs} file, call the minor mode command. The
e6cc673c5461 (Init Syntax): Explain about vars that do special
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 55834
diff changeset
2051 following section has examples of both of these methods.
e6cc673c5461 (Init Syntax): Explain about vars that do special
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 55834
diff changeset
2052
e6cc673c5461 (Init Syntax): Explain about vars that do special
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 55834
diff changeset
2053 The second argument to @code{setq} is an expression for the new
e6cc673c5461 (Init Syntax): Explain about vars that do special
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 55834
diff changeset
2054 value of the variable. This can be a constant, a variable, or a
e6cc673c5461 (Init Syntax): Explain about vars that do special
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 55834
diff changeset
2055 function call expression. In @file{.emacs}, constants are used most
e6cc673c5461 (Init Syntax): Explain about vars that do special
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 55834
diff changeset
2056 of the time. They can be:
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2057
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2058 @table @asis
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2059 @item Numbers:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2060 Numbers are written in decimal, with an optional initial minus sign.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2061
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2062 @item Strings:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2063 @cindex Lisp string syntax
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2064 @cindex string syntax
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2065 Lisp string syntax is the same as C string syntax with a few extra
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2066 features. Use a double-quote character to begin and end a string constant.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2067
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2068 In a string, you can include newlines and special characters literally.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2069 But often it is cleaner to use backslash sequences for them: @samp{\n}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2070 for newline, @samp{\b} for backspace, @samp{\r} for carriage return,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2071 @samp{\t} for tab, @samp{\f} for formfeed (control-L), @samp{\e} for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2072 escape, @samp{\\} for a backslash, @samp{\"} for a double-quote, or
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2073 @samp{\@var{ooo}} for the character whose octal code is @var{ooo}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2074 Backslash and double-quote are the only characters for which backslash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2075 sequences are mandatory.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2076
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2077 @samp{\C-} can be used as a prefix for a control character, as in
52979
3649390c0f91 Replace @sc{ascii} and ASCII with @acronym{ASCII}.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 52401
diff changeset
2078 @samp{\C-s} for @acronym{ASCII} control-S, and @samp{\M-} can be used as a prefix for
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2079 a Meta character, as in @samp{\M-a} for @kbd{Meta-A} or @samp{\M-\C-a} for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2080 @kbd{Control-Meta-A}.@refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2081
37198
12c496043cb0 (Init Syntax): Mention the -*-coding:-*- tag if .emacs uses non-ASCII
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37122
diff changeset
2082 @cindex international characters in @file{.emacs}
52979
3649390c0f91 Replace @sc{ascii} and ASCII with @acronym{ASCII}.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 52401
diff changeset
2083 @cindex non-@acronym{ASCII} characters in @file{.emacs}
3649390c0f91 Replace @sc{ascii} and ASCII with @acronym{ASCII}.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 52401
diff changeset
2084 If you want to include non-@acronym{ASCII} characters in strings in your init
37354
39aa69a68098 (Init Syntax): Add a cross reference to "Non-ASCII Rebinding".
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37265
diff changeset
2085 file, you should consider putting a @w{@samp{-*-coding:
39aa69a68098 (Init Syntax): Add a cross reference to "Non-ASCII Rebinding".
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37265
diff changeset
2086 @var{coding-system}-*-}} tag on the first line which states the coding
37265
d2c4a8eb274a (Init Syntax): Fix last change.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37198
diff changeset
2087 system used to save your @file{.emacs}, as explained in @ref{Recognize
52979
3649390c0f91 Replace @sc{ascii} and ASCII with @acronym{ASCII}.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 52401
diff changeset
2088 Coding}. This is because the defaults for decoding non-@acronym{ASCII} text might
37265
d2c4a8eb274a (Init Syntax): Fix last change.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37198
diff changeset
2089 not yet be set up by the time Emacs reads those parts of your init file
d2c4a8eb274a (Init Syntax): Fix last change.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37198
diff changeset
2090 which use such strings, possibly leading Emacs to decode those strings
d2c4a8eb274a (Init Syntax): Fix last change.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37198
diff changeset
2091 incorrectly.
37198
12c496043cb0 (Init Syntax): Mention the -*-coding:-*- tag if .emacs uses non-ASCII
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37122
diff changeset
2092
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2093 @item Characters:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2094 Lisp character constant syntax consists of a @samp{?} followed by
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2095 either a character or an escape sequence starting with @samp{\}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2096 Examples: @code{?x}, @code{?\n}, @code{?\"}, @code{?\)}. Note that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2097 strings and characters are not interchangeable in Lisp; some contexts
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2098 require one and some contexts require the other.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2099
37354
39aa69a68098 (Init Syntax): Add a cross reference to "Non-ASCII Rebinding".
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37265
diff changeset
2100 @xref{Non-ASCII Rebinding}, for information about binding commands to
52979
3649390c0f91 Replace @sc{ascii} and ASCII with @acronym{ASCII}.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 52401
diff changeset
2101 keys which send non-@acronym{ASCII} characters.
37354
39aa69a68098 (Init Syntax): Add a cross reference to "Non-ASCII Rebinding".
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37265
diff changeset
2102
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2103 @item True:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2104 @code{t} stands for `true'.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2105
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2106 @item False:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2107 @code{nil} stands for `false'.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2108
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2109 @item Other Lisp objects:
37976
23dc2eca0bd3 Proofreading changes from Tim Goodwin <tjg@star.le.ac.uk>.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37843
diff changeset
2110 Write a single-quote (@code{'}) followed by the Lisp object you want.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2111 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2112
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2113 @node Init Examples
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2114 @subsection Init File Examples
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2115
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2116 Here are some examples of doing certain commonly desired things with
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2117 Lisp expressions:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2118
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2119 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2120 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2121 Make @key{TAB} in C mode just insert a tab if point is in the middle of a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2122 line.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2123
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2124 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2125 (setq c-tab-always-indent nil)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2126 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2127
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2128 Here we have a variable whose value is normally @code{t} for `true'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2129 and the alternative is @code{nil} for `false'.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2130
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2131 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2132 Make searches case sensitive by default (in all buffers that do not
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2133 override this).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2134
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2135 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2136 (setq-default case-fold-search nil)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2137 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2138
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2139 This sets the default value, which is effective in all buffers that do
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2140 not have local values for the variable. Setting @code{case-fold-search}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2141 with @code{setq} affects only the current buffer's local value, which
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2142 is not what you probably want to do in an init file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2143
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2144 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2145 @vindex user-mail-address
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2146 Specify your own email address, if Emacs can't figure it out correctly.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2147
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2148 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2149 (setq user-mail-address "coon@@yoyodyne.com")
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2150 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2151
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2152 Various Emacs packages that need your own email address use the value of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2153 @code{user-mail-address}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2154
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2155 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2156 Make Text mode the default mode for new buffers.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2157
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2158 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2159 (setq default-major-mode 'text-mode)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2160 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2161
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2162 Note that @code{text-mode} is used because it is the command for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2163 entering Text mode. The single-quote before it makes the symbol a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2164 constant; otherwise, @code{text-mode} would be treated as a variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2165 name.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2166
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2167 @need 1500
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2168 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2169 Set up defaults for the Latin-1 character set
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2170 which supports most of the languages of Western Europe.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2171
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2172 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2173 (set-language-environment "Latin-1")
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2174 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2175
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2176 @need 1500
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2177 @item
56085
e6cc673c5461 (Init Syntax): Explain about vars that do special
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 55834
diff changeset
2178 Turn off Line Number mode, a global minor mode.
e6cc673c5461 (Init Syntax): Explain about vars that do special
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 55834
diff changeset
2179
e6cc673c5461 (Init Syntax): Explain about vars that do special
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 55834
diff changeset
2180 @example
e6cc673c5461 (Init Syntax): Explain about vars that do special
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 55834
diff changeset
2181 (line-number-mode 0)
e6cc673c5461 (Init Syntax): Explain about vars that do special
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 55834
diff changeset
2182 @end example
e6cc673c5461 (Init Syntax): Explain about vars that do special
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 55834
diff changeset
2183
e6cc673c5461 (Init Syntax): Explain about vars that do special
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 55834
diff changeset
2184 @need 1500
e6cc673c5461 (Init Syntax): Explain about vars that do special
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 55834
diff changeset
2185 @item
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2186 Turn on Auto Fill mode automatically in Text mode and related modes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2187
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2188 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2189 (add-hook 'text-mode-hook
36148
a2719b6e7a2f Don't use naked lambdas in examples. Fix bad @xref usage.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35188
diff changeset
2190 '(lambda () (auto-fill-mode 1)))
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2191 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2192
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2193 This shows how to add a hook function to a normal hook variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2194 (@pxref{Hooks}). The function we supply is a list starting with
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2195 @code{lambda}, with a single-quote in front of it to make it a list
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2196 constant rather than an expression.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2197
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2198 It's beyond the scope of this manual to explain Lisp functions, but for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2199 this example it is enough to know that the effect is to execute
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2200 @code{(auto-fill-mode 1)} when Text mode is entered. You can replace
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2201 that with any other expression that you like, or with several
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2202 expressions in a row.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2203
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2204 Emacs comes with a function named @code{turn-on-auto-fill} whose
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2205 definition is @code{(lambda () (auto-fill-mode 1))}. Thus, a simpler
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2206 way to write the above example is as follows:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2207
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2208 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2209 (add-hook 'text-mode-hook 'turn-on-auto-fill)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2210 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2211
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2212 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2213 Load the installed Lisp library named @file{foo} (actually a file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2214 @file{foo.elc} or @file{foo.el} in a standard Emacs directory).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2215
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2216 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2217 (load "foo")
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2218 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2219
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2220 When the argument to @code{load} is a relative file name, not starting
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2221 with @samp{/} or @samp{~}, @code{load} searches the directories in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2222 @code{load-path} (@pxref{Lisp Libraries}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2223
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2224 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2225 Load the compiled Lisp file @file{foo.elc} from your home directory.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2226
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2227 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2228 (load "~/foo.elc")
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2229 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2230
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2231 Here an absolute file name is used, so no searching is done.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2232
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2233 @item
37354
39aa69a68098 (Init Syntax): Add a cross reference to "Non-ASCII Rebinding".
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37265
diff changeset
2234 @cindex loading Lisp libraries automatically
39aa69a68098 (Init Syntax): Add a cross reference to "Non-ASCII Rebinding".
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37265
diff changeset
2235 @cindex autoload Lisp libraries
38114
4face9462576 Minor clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37977
diff changeset
2236 Tell Emacs to find the definition for the function @code{myfunction}
4face9462576 Minor clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37977
diff changeset
2237 by loading a Lisp library named @file{mypackage} (i.e.@: a file
4face9462576 Minor clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37977
diff changeset
2238 @file{mypackage.elc} or @file{mypackage.el}):
37354
39aa69a68098 (Init Syntax): Add a cross reference to "Non-ASCII Rebinding".
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37265
diff changeset
2239
39aa69a68098 (Init Syntax): Add a cross reference to "Non-ASCII Rebinding".
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37265
diff changeset
2240 @example
39aa69a68098 (Init Syntax): Add a cross reference to "Non-ASCII Rebinding".
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37265
diff changeset
2241 (autoload 'myfunction "mypackage" "Do what I say." t)
39aa69a68098 (Init Syntax): Add a cross reference to "Non-ASCII Rebinding".
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37265
diff changeset
2242 @end example
39aa69a68098 (Init Syntax): Add a cross reference to "Non-ASCII Rebinding".
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37265
diff changeset
2243
39aa69a68098 (Init Syntax): Add a cross reference to "Non-ASCII Rebinding".
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37265
diff changeset
2244 @noindent
38114
4face9462576 Minor clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37977
diff changeset
2245 Here the string @code{"Do what I say."} is the function's
4face9462576 Minor clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37977
diff changeset
2246 documentation string. You specify it in the @code{autoload}
4face9462576 Minor clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37977
diff changeset
2247 definition so it will be available for help commands even when the
4face9462576 Minor clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37977
diff changeset
2248 package is not loaded. The last argument, @code{t}, indicates that
4face9462576 Minor clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37977
diff changeset
2249 this function is interactive; that is, it can be invoked interactively
4face9462576 Minor clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37977
diff changeset
2250 by typing @kbd{M-x myfunction @key{RET}} or by binding it to a key.
4face9462576 Minor clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37977
diff changeset
2251 If the function is not interactive, omit the @code{t} or use
4face9462576 Minor clarifications.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37977
diff changeset
2252 @code{nil}.
37354
39aa69a68098 (Init Syntax): Add a cross reference to "Non-ASCII Rebinding".
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37265
diff changeset
2253
39aa69a68098 (Init Syntax): Add a cross reference to "Non-ASCII Rebinding".
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37265
diff changeset
2254 @item
59949
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
2255 Rebind the key @kbd{C-x l} to run the function @code{make-symbolic-link}
59961
f8a952f61ced (Init Examples): Fix previous fix.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents: 59957
diff changeset
2256 (@pxref{Init Rebinding}).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2257
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2258 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2259 (global-set-key "\C-xl" 'make-symbolic-link)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2260 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2261
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2262 or
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2263
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2264 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2265 (define-key global-map "\C-xl" 'make-symbolic-link)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2266 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2267
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2268 Note once again the single-quote used to refer to the symbol
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2269 @code{make-symbolic-link} instead of its value as a variable.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2270
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2271 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2272 Do the same thing for Lisp mode only.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2273
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2274 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2275 (define-key lisp-mode-map "\C-xl" 'make-symbolic-link)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2276 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2277
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2278 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2279 Redefine all keys which now run @code{next-line} in Fundamental mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2280 so that they run @code{forward-line} instead.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2281
26392
b3d3ff9a7a2c *** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2282 @findex substitute-key-definition
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2283 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2284 (substitute-key-definition 'next-line 'forward-line
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2285 global-map)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2286 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2287
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2288 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2289 Make @kbd{C-x C-v} undefined.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2290
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2291 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2292 (global-unset-key "\C-x\C-v")
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2293 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2294
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2295 One reason to undefine a key is so that you can make it a prefix.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2296 Simply defining @kbd{C-x C-v @var{anything}} will make @kbd{C-x C-v} a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2297 prefix, but @kbd{C-x C-v} must first be freed of its usual non-prefix
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2298 definition.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2299
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2300 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2301 Make @samp{$} have the syntax of punctuation in Text mode.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2302 Note the use of a character constant for @samp{$}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2303
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2304 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2305 (modify-syntax-entry ?\$ "." text-mode-syntax-table)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2306 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2307
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2308 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2309 Enable the use of the command @code{narrow-to-region} without confirmation.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2310
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2311 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2312 (put 'narrow-to-region 'disabled nil)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2313 @end example
61606
e348d86e70f8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 61051
diff changeset
2314
e348d86e70f8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 61051
diff changeset
2315 @item
e348d86e70f8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 61051
diff changeset
2316 Adjusting the configuration to various contexts.
e348d86e70f8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 61051
diff changeset
2317
e348d86e70f8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 61051
diff changeset
2318 In most of the cases, people want their Emacs to behave the same on
e348d86e70f8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 61051
diff changeset
2319 all their machines, so their configuration should be the same, no
e348d86e70f8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 61051
diff changeset
2320 matter whether it's GNU/Linux or not, under X11 or on a tty, with one
e348d86e70f8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 61051
diff changeset
2321 version of Emacs or another, ...
e348d86e70f8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 61051
diff changeset
2322
e348d86e70f8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 61051
diff changeset
2323 What can happen, tho, is that depending on the circumstance some
e348d86e70f8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 61051
diff changeset
2324 features may or may not be available. In that case just prepend each
e348d86e70f8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 61051
diff changeset
2325 such customization with a little test that ensures that the feature
e348d86e70f8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 61051
diff changeset
2326 can be used. The best tests are usually checking that the feature is
e348d86e70f8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 61051
diff changeset
2327 available, rather than checking what kind of environment is
e348d86e70f8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 61051
diff changeset
2328 being used.
e348d86e70f8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 61051
diff changeset
2329
e348d86e70f8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 61051
diff changeset
2330 @example
e348d86e70f8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 61051
diff changeset
2331 (if (fboundp 'blinking-cursor-mode)
e348d86e70f8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 61051
diff changeset
2332 (blinking-cursor-mode 0))
e348d86e70f8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 61051
diff changeset
2333 @end example
e348d86e70f8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 61051
diff changeset
2334
e348d86e70f8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 61051
diff changeset
2335 @example
e348d86e70f8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 61051
diff changeset
2336 (if (boundp 'coding-category-utf-8)
e348d86e70f8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 61051
diff changeset
2337 (set-coding-priority '(coding-category-utf-8)))
e348d86e70f8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 61051
diff changeset
2338 @end example
e348d86e70f8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 61051
diff changeset
2339
e348d86e70f8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 61051
diff changeset
2340 @example
e348d86e70f8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 61051
diff changeset
2341 (require 'cl) ; To define `ignore-errors'.
e348d86e70f8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 61051
diff changeset
2342 (ignore-errors (set-face-background 'region "grey75"))
e348d86e70f8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 61051
diff changeset
2343 @end example
e348d86e70f8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 61051
diff changeset
2344
e348d86e70f8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 61051
diff changeset
2345 Note also that a @code{setq} on a variable which does not exist is
e348d86e70f8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 61051
diff changeset
2346 generally harmless, so those usually do not need to be made
e348d86e70f8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 61051
diff changeset
2347 conditional on any kind of test.
e348d86e70f8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 61051
diff changeset
2348
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2349 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2350
61606
e348d86e70f8 *** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 61051
diff changeset
2351
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2352 @node Terminal Init
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2353 @subsection Terminal-specific Initialization
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2354
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2355 Each terminal type can have a Lisp library to be loaded into Emacs when
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2356 it is run on that type of terminal. For a terminal type named
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2357 @var{termtype}, the library is called @file{term/@var{termtype}} and it is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2358 found by searching the directories @code{load-path} as usual and trying the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2359 suffixes @samp{.elc} and @samp{.el}. Normally it appears in the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2360 subdirectory @file{term} of the directory where most Emacs libraries are
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2361 kept.@refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2362
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2363 The usual purpose of the terminal-specific library is to map the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2364 escape sequences used by the terminal's function keys onto more
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2365 meaningful names, using @code{function-key-map}. See the file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2366 @file{term/lk201.el} for an example of how this is done. Many function
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2367 keys are mapped automatically according to the information in the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2368 Termcap data base; the terminal-specific library needs to map only the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2369 function keys that Termcap does not specify.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2370
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2371 When the terminal type contains a hyphen, only the part of the name
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2372 before the first hyphen is significant in choosing the library name.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2373 Thus, terminal types @samp{aaa-48} and @samp{aaa-30-rv} both use
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2374 the library @file{term/aaa}. The code in the library can use
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2375 @code{(getenv "TERM")} to find the full terminal type name.@refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2376
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2377 @vindex term-file-prefix
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2378 The library's name is constructed by concatenating the value of the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2379 variable @code{term-file-prefix} and the terminal type. Your @file{.emacs}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2380 file can prevent the loading of the terminal-specific library by setting
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2381 @code{term-file-prefix} to @code{nil}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2382
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2383 @vindex term-setup-hook
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2384 Emacs runs the hook @code{term-setup-hook} at the end of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2385 initialization, after both your @file{.emacs} file and any
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2386 terminal-specific library have been read in. Add hook functions to this
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2387 hook if you wish to override part of any of the terminal-specific
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2388 libraries and to define initializations for terminals that do not have a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2389 library. @xref{Hooks}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2390
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2391 @node Find Init
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2392 @subsection How Emacs Finds Your Init File
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2393
29107
203ba1f77b7b *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28344
diff changeset
2394 Normally Emacs uses the environment variable @env{HOME} to find
59949
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
2395 @file{.emacs}; that's what @samp{~} means in a file name. If @file{.emacs}
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
2396 is not found directly inside @file{~/}, Emacs looks for it in
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
2397 @file{~/.emacs.d/}.
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
2398
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
2399 However, if you run Emacs from a shell started by @code{su}, Emacs
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
2400 tries to find your own @file{.emacs}, not that of the user you are
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
2401 currently pretending to be. The idea is that you should get your own
7c5b107612a0 (Minor Modes): Fix typo.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59802
diff changeset
2402 editor customizations even if you are running as the super user.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2403
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2404 More precisely, Emacs first determines which user's init file to use.
29107
203ba1f77b7b *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28344
diff changeset
2405 It gets the user name from the environment variables @env{LOGNAME} and
203ba1f77b7b *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28344
diff changeset
2406 @env{USER}; if neither of those exists, it uses effective user-ID.
203ba1f77b7b *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 28344
diff changeset
2407 If that user name matches the real user-ID, then Emacs uses @env{HOME};
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2408 otherwise, it looks up the home directory corresponding to that user
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2409 name in the system's data base of users.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2410 @c LocalWords: backtab
52401
695cf19ef79e Add arch taglines
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 52227
diff changeset
2411
695cf19ef79e Add arch taglines
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 52227
diff changeset
2412 @ignore
695cf19ef79e Add arch taglines
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 52227
diff changeset
2413 arch-tag: c68abddb-4410-4fb5-925f-63394e971d93
695cf19ef79e Add arch taglines
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 52227
diff changeset
2414 @end ignore